38D5 Group REJ03B0158-0304 Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 SINGLE-CHIP 8-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER DESCRIPTION The 38D5 Group is the 8-bit microcomputer based on the 740 Family core technology. The 38D5 Group is pin-compatible with the 38C5 Group. The 38D5 Group has an LCD drive control circuit, an A/D converter, a serial interface, and a ROM correction function as additional functions. The QzROM version and the flash memory version are available. The flash memory version does not have a selection function for the oscillation start mode. Only the on-chip oscillator starts oscillating. The various microcomputers include variations of memory size, and packaging. For details, refer to the section on part numbering. FEATURES • Power source voltage (QzROM version) [In frequency/2 mode] f(XIN) ≤ 12.5 MHz.............................................. 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz................................................... 4.0 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4 MHz................................................... 2.0 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 2 MHz................................................... 1.8 to 5.5 V [In frequency/4 mode] f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz................................................. 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz................................................... 2.0 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4 MHz................................................... 1.8 to 5.5 V [In frequency/8 mode] f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz................................................. 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz................................................... 2.0 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4 MHz................................................... 1.8 to 5.5 V [In low-speed mode].............................................. 1.8 to 5.5 V Note. 12.5 MHz < f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz is not available in the frequency/2 mode. • Basic machine-language instructions ................................. 71 • The minimum instruction execution time ................... 0.32 µs (at 12.5 MHz oscillation frequency) • Memory size (QzROM version) ROM ........................................................ 32 K to 60 K bytes RAM ......................................................... 1536 to 2048 bytes • Memory size (Flash memory version) ROM ...................................................................... 60 K bytes RAM ...................................................................... 2048 bytes • Programmable input/output ports .. 59 (common to SEG: 36) • Interrupts ............................................. 17 sources, 16 vectors (Key input interrupt included) • Timers ..................................................... 8-bit × 4, 16-bit × 2 • Serial interface Serial I/O1 ...............8-bit × 1 (UART or Clock-synchronized) Serial I/O2 .............................. 8-bit × 1 (Clock-synchronized) • PWM .......... 10-bit × 2, 16-bit × 1 (common to IGBT output) • A/D converter .......................................... 10-bit × 8 channels (A/D converter can be operated in low-speed mode.) • Watchdog timer ......................................................... 8-bit × 1 • ROM correction function ....................... 32 bytes × 2 vectors • LED direct drive port ............................................................ 6 (average current: 15 mA, peak current: 30 mA, total current: 90 mA) • LCD drive control circuit Bias ............................................................................ 1/2, 1/3 Duty ............................................................... Static, 2, 3, 4, 8 Common output ................................................................. 4/8 Segment output .............................................................. 32/36 • Main clock generating circuit ............................................... 1 (connect to external ceramic resonator or on-chip oscillator) • Sub-clock generating circuit ..................................................1 (connect to external quartz-crystal oscillator) • Power source voltage (Flash memory version) [In frequency/2 mode] f(XIN) ≤ 12.5 MHz.............................................. 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz................................................... 4.0 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4 MHz................................................... 2.7 to 5.5 V [In frequency/4 mode] f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz................................................. 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz................................................... 2.7 to 5.5 V [In frequency/8 mode] f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz................................................. 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz................................................... 2.7 to 5.5 V [In low-speed mode].............................................. 2.7 to 5.5 V Note. 12.5 MHz < f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz is not available in the frequency/2 mode. • Power dissipation (QzROM version) • In frequency/2 mode ..................................... Typ. 32 mW (VCC = 5 V, f(XIN) = 12.5 MHz, Ta = 25°C) • In low-speed mode ........................................ Typ. 18 µW (VCC = 2.5 V, f(XIN) = stop, f(XCIN) = 32 kHz, Ta = 25°C) • Power dissipation (Flash memory version) • In frequency/2 mode ..................................... Typ. 20 mW (VCC = 5 V, f(XIN) = 12.5 MHz, Ta = 25°C) • In low-speed mode ...................................... Typ. 1.1 mW (VCC = 2.7 V, f(XIN) = stop, f(XCIN) = 32 kHz, Ta = 25°C) • Operating temperature range ............................... −20 to 85°C Flash Memory Mode • Program/Erase voltage ............................. VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V • Program method ....................... Programming in unit of byte • Erase method .................................................... Block erasing • Program/Erase control by software command APPLICATION Household products, Consumer electronics, etc. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 1 of 134 Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Fig. 1 Pin configuration (QFP Package) Page 2 of 134 21 22 23 24 V L2 V L1 20 19 18 17 P7 1/C 2 /INT 11 P7 0/C 1/INT 01 P7 2/T 2OUT/CKOUT V L3 P7 4/PWM 1 /T 4OUT P7 3/PWM 0/T 3OUT 16 15 14 13 74 12 73 11 72 10 71 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 P47/SRDY2/(KW3) P46/SCLK2/(KW2) P45/SOUT2/(KW1) P44/SIN2/(KW0) P43/SRDY1 P42/SCLK1 P41/TXD P40/RXD AVSS VREF P57/AN7/ADKEY0 P56/AN6 P55/AN5 P54/AN4 P53/AN3 P52/AN2 RESET P6 1/X COUT P6 0/X CIN V SS X IN X OUT V CC P5 1/AN 1/RTP 1 P5 0/AN 0/RTP 0 P6 7/CNTR 1/(LED 5) P6 6/INT 10/CNTR 0/(LED 4) P6 5/T XOUT1 /(LED 3) P6 4/INT 2/(LED 2) P6 3/T XOUT2/(LED 1) P6 2 /INT 00/(LED 0) OSCSEL (Note 1) Package type : PRQP0080GB-A(80P6N-A) 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 P1 5/SEG 21 P1 6/SEG 22 P17/SEG 23 P1 3/SEG 19 P1 4/SEG 20 P12/SEG 18 P2 0/SEG 0/(KW 4) P2 1/SEG 1/(KW 5) P2 2/SEG 2/(KW 6) P2 3/SEG 3/(KW 7) P2 4/SEG 4 P2 5/SEG 5 P2 6/SEG 6 P2 7/SEG 7 P0 0/SEG 8 P0 1/SEG 9 P0 2/SEG 10 P0 3/SEG 11 P0 4/SEG 12 P0 5/SEG 13 P0 6/SEG 14 P0 7/SEG 15 P10/SEG 16 P11/SEG 17 38D5 Group PIN CONFIGURATION (TOP VIEW) 65 40 66 39 67 38 68 37 69 36 70 35 M38D5XGXFP M38D59FFFP 34 32 33 31 75 76 30 29 77 28 78 27 79 26 80 25 P30/SEG24 P31/SEG25 P32/SEG26 P33/SEG27 P34/SEG28 P35/SEG29 P36/SEG30 P37/SEG31 COM7/SEG32 COM6/SEG33 COM5/SEG34 COM4/SEG35 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 Note 1: CNVSS in flash memory version P1 3 /SEG 19 P1 4 /SEG 20 P1 5 /SEG 21 43 42 41 45 44 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 61 40 62 39 63 38 64 37 65 36 66 35 67 34 68 33 69 32 M38D5XGXHP M38D59FFHP 70 71 72 31 30 29 73 28 74 27 75 26 18 19 20 V L3 V L2 P7 1/C 2/INT 11 17 P7 2/T 2OUT /CKOUT 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 16 P6 4/INT 2/(LED 2) P6 3/T XOUT2/(LED 1) P6 2/INT 00 /(LED 0) OSCSEL (Note 1) P6 7/CNTR 1/(LED 5) P6 6/INT 10/CNTR 0/(LED 4) P6 5/T XOUT1/(LED 3) RESET P6 1/X COUT P6 0/X CIN V SS X IN X OUT V CC P7 4/PWM 1/T 4OUT P7 3 /PWM 0/T 3OUT 21 7 22 80 6 23 79 5 78 4 24 3 25 77 2 76 1 P21/SEG1/(KW5) P20/SEG0/(KW4) P47/SRDY2/(KW3) P46/SCLK2/(KW2) P45/SOUT2/(KW1) P44/SIN2/(KW0) P43/SRDY1 P42/SCLK1 P41/TXD P40/RXD AVSS VREF P57/AN7/ADKEY0 P56/AN6 P55/AN5 P54/AN4 P53/AN3 P52/AN2 P51/AN1/RTP1 P50/AN0/RTP0 59 60 PIN CONFIGURATION (TOP VIEW) P2 2/SEG 2/(KW 6) P2 3/SEG 3/(KW 7) P2 4/SEG 4 P2 5/SEG 5 P2 6/SEG 6 P2 7/SEG 7 P0 0/SEG 8 P0 1/SEG 9 P0 2/SEG 10 P0 3/SEG 11 P0 4/SEG 12 P0 5/SEG 13 P0 6/SEG 14 P0 7/SEG 15 P1 0/SEG 16 P1 1/SEG 17 P1 2/SEG 18 38D5 Group Package type : PLQP0080KB-A(80P6Q-A) Fig. 2 Pin configuration (LQFP package) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 3 of 134 P16/SEG22 P17/SEG23 P30/SEG24 P31/SEG25 P32/SEG26 P33/SEG27 P34/SEG28 P35/SEG29 P36/SEG30 P37/SEG31 COM7/SEG32 COM6/SEG33 COM5/SEG34 COM4/SEG35 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 VL1 P70/C1/INT01 Note 1: CNVSS in flash memory version 38D5 Group Table 1 Performance overview (1) Parameter Function Number of basic instructions 71 Instruction execution time 0.32 µs (Minimum instruction, Oscillation frequency 12.5 MHz) Oscillation frequency 16 MHz (Maximum)(1) Memory sizes (QzROM version) ROM 32 K to 60 K bytes RAM 1536 to 2048 bytes ROM Memory sizes (Flash memory version) RAM 60 K bytes 2048 bytes 2-bit × 1 Input port P70, P71 I/O port P0-P6, P72-P74 8-bit × 7, 3-bit × 1 (36 pins sharing SEG) Interrupt 17 sources, 16 vectors (includes key input interrupt) Timer 8-bit × 4, 16-bit × 2 Serial I/O1 8-bit × 1 (UART or Clock-synchronized) Serial I/O2 8-bit × 1 (Clock-synchronized) PWM 10-bit × 2, 16-bit × 1 (common to IGBT output) A/D converter 10-bit × 8 (operated in low-speed mode) Watchdog timer 8-bit × 1 ROM correction function 32 bytes × 2 vectors LED direct drive port 6 (average current: 15 mA, peak current: 30 mA, total current: 90 mA) LCD drive control circuit Bias 1/2, 1/3 Duty Static, 2, 3, 4, 8 Common output 4/8 Segment output 32/36 Main clock generating circuits Built-in (connect to external ceramic resonator or on-chip oscillator) Sub-clock generating circuits Power source voltage (QzROM version) Built-in (connect to external quartz-crystal oscillator) In frequency/2 mode f(XIN) ≤ 12.5 MHz 4.5 to 5.5 V (1) f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz 4.0 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4 MHz 2.0 to 5.5 V In frequency/4 mode In frequency/8 mode f(XIN) ≤ 2 MHz 1.8 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz 2.0 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4 MHz 1.8 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz 2.0 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4 MHz 1.8 to 5.5 V In low-speed mode Power source voltage In frequency/2 mode (Flash memory version) (1) 1.8 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 12.5 MHz 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz 4.0 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4 MHz 2.7 to 5.5 V In frequency/4 mode f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz 2.7 to 5.5 V In frequency/8 mode f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz 4.5 to 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz 2.7 to 5.5 V In low-speed mode NOTE: 2.7 to 5.5 V 1. 12.5 MHz < f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz is not available in the frequency/2 mode. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 4 of 134 38D5 Group Table 2 Performance overview (2) Parameter Function Power dissipation (QzROM version) In frequency/2 mode Std. 32 mW (Vcc = 5 V, f(XIN) = 12.5 MHz, Ta = 25°C) In low-speed mode Std. 18 µW (Vcc = 2.5 V, f(XIN) = stop, f(XCIN) = 32 kHz, Ta = 25°C) Power dissipation (Flash memory version) In frequency/2 mode Std. 20 mW (Vcc = 5 V, f(XIN) = 12.5 MHz, Ta = 25°C) In low-speed mode Std. 1.1 mW (Vcc = 2.7 V, f(XIN) = stop, f(XCIN) = 32 kHz, Ta = 25°C) Input/Output withstand voltage VCC Input/Output characteristics Output current Operating temperature range 10 mA -20 to 85°C Device structure CMOS silicon gate Package 80-pin plastic molded LQFP/QFP Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 5 of 134 -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- Fig. 3 Functional block diagram Page 6 of 134 8 8 Port P5 (8) 4 COM × 36 SEG 8 COM × 32 SEG or LCD drive control circuit ROM correction Serial I/O2 (Clock synchronous) 8 8 Timer 3 2 Port P7 (5) Watchdog timer PWM1 (10 bits) Timer 4 (8 bits) PWM0 (10 bits) Timer 3 (8 bits) Timer 2 (8 bits) Timer 1 (8 bits) Timer Y (16 bits) IGBT output PWM (16 bits) CPU core Port P3 (8) Timer X (16 bits) Port P6 (8) Serial I/O1 (UART or Clock synchronous) Serial I/O A/D converter 10-bits × 8-channels 8 Port P2 (8) Internal peripheral function Port P1 (8) 8 On-chip oscillator RAM RAM for LCD display (36 bytes) ROM Memory X IN –X OUT (Main clock) X CIN –X COUT (Sub-clock) System clock φ generation --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Port P4 (8) Port P0 (8) 8 --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM 38D5 Group 38D5 Group PIN DESCRIPTION Table 3 Pin description (1) Pin Name Function Function except a port function VCC, VSS Power source • Apply power source voltage to VCC, and 0 V to VSS. RESET Reset input • Reset input pin for active “L”. • Input and output pins for the main clock generating circuit. • Connect a ceramic resonator or a quartz-crystal oscillator between the XIN and XOUT pins to set the oscillation frequency. When an external clock is used, connect the clock source to XIN, and leave XOUT pin open. • Feedback resistor is built in between XIN pin and XOUT pin. XIN Clock input XOUT Clock output VL1, VL2, VL3 LCD power source • Input 0 ≤ VL1 ≤ VL2 ≤ VL3 voltage. • Input 0 − VL3 voltage to LCD. COM0− COM3 Common output • LCD common output pins. • COM2 and COM3 are not used at 1/2 duty ratio. • COM3 is not used at 1/3 duty ratio. COM4/SEG35− COM7/SEG32 Common output Segment output • LCD common/segment output pins. P00/SEG8− P07/SEG15 I/O port P0 • • • • P10/SEG16− P17/SEG23 I/O port P1 • • • • P20/SEG0/(KW4)− P23/SEG3/(KW7) I/O port P2 • • • • P30/SEG24− P37/SEG31 I/O port P3 • • • • P40/RXD P41/TXD P42/SCLK1 P43/SRDY1 I/O port P4 • • • • P24/SEG4− P27/SEG7 P44/SIN2/(KW0) P45/SOUT2/(KW1) P46/SCLK2/(KW2) P47/SRDY2/(KW3) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 8-bit I/O port. CMOS compatible input level. CMOS 3-state output structure. I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually programmed as either input or output. • Pull-up control is enabled in a bit unit. 8-bit I/O port. CMOS compatible input level. CMOS 3-state output structure. I/O direction register allows each pin to be programmed as either input or output. • Pull-up control is enabled in 4-bit unit. 8-bit I/O port. CMOS compatible input level. CMOS 3-state output structure. I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually programmed as either input or output. • Pull-up control is enabled in a bit unit. • Key input interrupt input pins 8-bit I/O port. CMOS compatible input level. CMOS 3-state output structure. I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually programmed as either input or output. • Pull-up control is enabled in 4-bit unit. • Serial I/O1 function pins 8-bit I/O port. CMOS compatible input level. CMOS 3-state output structure. I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually programmed as either input or output. • Serial I/O2 • Key input interrupt • Pull-up control is enabled in 4-bit unit. function pins input pins Page 7 of 134 38D5 Group Table 4 Pin description (2) Pin P50/AN0/RTP0 P51/AN1/RTP1 Name Function • • • • P52/AN2− P56/AN6 P57/AN7/ADKEY0 P60/XCIN P61/XCOUT Function except a port function • AD converter 8-bit I/O port. input pins CMOS compatible input level. CMOS 3-state output structure. I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually programmed as either input or output. • Pull-up control is enabled in a bit unit. I/O port P5 I/O port P6 P65/TXOUT1/(LED3) P66/INT10/CNTR0/ (LED4) • ADKEY input pin 8-bit I/O port. CMOS compatible input level. CMOS 3-state output structure. I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually programmed as either input or output. • Pull-up control is enabled in a bit unit. • P62 to P67 (6 bits) are enabled to output large current for LED drive. • Sub clock generating I/O pins (oscillator connected) • Timer X, Timer Y output pins • External interrupt pins • External interrupt pins • External capacitor connect pins for a voltage multiplier of LCD. • • • • P62/INT00/(LED0) P63/TXOUT2/(LED1) P64/INT2/(LED2) • Real time port function pins • External interrupt pin • Timer X output pin • External interrupt pin • Timer X output pin P67/CNTR1/(LED5) P70/C1/INT01 P71/C2/INT11 Input port P7 • 2-bit input port. • CMOS input level. P72/T2OUT/CKOUT I/O port P7 • • • • • Clock output pin 3-bit I/O port. CMOS compatible input level. • PWM output pins CMOS 3-state output structure. I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually programmed as either input or output. • Pull-up control is enabled in 3-bit unit. P73/PWM0/T3OUT P74/PWM1/T4OUT OSCSEL (Only QzROM version) Oscillation start selection pin CNVSS CNVSS (Only flash memory version) • Timer 4 output pin • Whether oscillation starts by an oscillator between the XIN and XOUT pins or an on-chip oscillator is selected. • VPP power source input pin in the QzROM writing mode. • Pin for controlling the operating mode of the chip. Connect to VSS. VREF Analog reference • Reference voltage input pin for A/D converter. voltage AVSS Analog power source Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 • Timer 2 output pin • Timer 3 output pin • Analog power source input pin for A/D converter. Connect to VSS. Page 8 of 134 38D5 Group PART NUMBERING Product M38D5 8 G 8 - XXX FP Package type FP: PRQP0080GB-A package HP: PLQP0080KB-A package ROM number Omitted in the shipped in blank version. ROM memory size 1 : 4096 bytes 9 : 36864 bytes 2 : 8192 bytes A : 40960 bytes 3 : 12288 bytes B : 45056 bytes 4 : 16384 bytes C : 49152 bytes 5 : 20480 bytes D : 53248 bytes 6 : 24576 bytes E : 57344 bytes 7 : 28672 bytes F : 61440 bytes 8 : 32768 bytes The first 128 bytes and the last 2 bytes of ROM are reserved areas ; they cannot be used. Memory type G : QzROM version F : Flash memory version RAM size 0 : 192 bytes 1 : 256 bytes 2 : 384 bytes 3 : 512 bytes 4 : 640 bytes 5 : 768 bytes 6 : 896 bytes 7 : 1024 bytes 8 : 1536 bytes 9 : 2048 bytes Fig. 4 Part numbering Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 9 of 134 38D5 Group GROUP EXPANSION Renesas plans to expand the 38D5 Group as follows. Packages • PRQP0080GB-A ................. 0.8 mm-pitch plastic molded QFP • PLQP0080KB-A ...............0.5 mm-pitch plastic molded LQFP Memory Size <QzROM version> • ROM size ................................................... 32 K to 60 K bytes • RAM size .................................................. 1536 to 2048 bytes <Flash memory version> • ROM size ................................................................ 60 K bytes • RAM size ............................................................... 2048 bytes Memory Expansion Plan M38D59GF/FF ROM size 60K (bytes) 56K M38D59GC 48K 40K M38D58G8 32K 28K 24K 20K 16K 12K 8K 4K 192 256 384 512 640 768 896 1,024 1,536 2,048 RAM size (bytes) Fig. 5 Memory expansion plan Currently supported products are listed below. Table 5 Support products Part No. M38D58G8-XXXFP As of Apr. 2008 ROM size (bytes) ROM size for User in ( ) RAM size (bytes) Package 32768 (32638) 1536 PRQP0080GB-A M38D58G8-XXXHP M38D58G8FP 32768 (32638) 1536 49152 (49022) 2048 49152 (49022) 2048 61440 (61310) 2048 61440 (61310) PRQP0080GB-A QzROM version (blank) PRQP0080GB-A QzROM version 2048 PRQP0080GB-A QzROM version (blank) PLQP0080KB-A 61440 (61310) M38D59FFHP Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 QzROM version PLQP0080KB-A M38D59GFHP M38D59FFFP PRQP0080GB-A PLQP0080KB-A M38D59GF-XXXHP M38D59GFFP QzROM version (blank) PLQP0080KB-A M38D59GCHP M38D59GF-XXXFP PRQP0080GB-A PLQP0080KB-A M38D59GC-XXXHP M38D59GCFP QzROM version PLQP0080KB-A M38D58G8HP M38D59GC-XXXFP Remarks 2048 PRQP0080GB-A PLQP0080KB-A Page 10 of 134 Flash memory version 38D5 Group Table 6 Differences between QzROM and flash memory versions QzROM version Flash memory version Main clock XIN or on-chip oscillator selectable Oscillation circuit at reset and at returning from stop mode by OSCSEL pin On-chip oscillator Termination of OSCEL/CNVSS pin OSCSEL = “H” OSCSEL = “L” CNVSS = “L” Main clock oscillation at reset and at returning from stop mode Oscillation on Stop Stop On-chip oscillator oscillation at reset and at returning from stop mode Stop Oscillation on Oscillation on f(XIN)/8 f(OCO)/32 f(OCO)/32 Required Optional System clock φ oscillation at reset and at returning from stop mode Mounting of main clock oscillation circuit Optional On-chip oscillator oscillation in low speed-mode Stop Stop by setting the on-chip oscillator stop bit because it is not stopped. Writing “1” to on-chip oscillator stop bit in on-chip oscillator mode On-chip oscillator is stopped On-chip oscillator is not stopped Reset input “L” pulse width Absolute maximum rating: OSCSEL/CNVSS pin 2 µs or more 2 ms or more −0.3 to 8.0 −0.3 to VCC + 0.3 Minimum operating power source voltage 1.8 V 2.7 V A/D converter minimum operating power source voltage 2.0 V 2.7 V NOTE: 1. For detailed specifications, confirm the descriptions in the Datasheet. Notes on Differences between QzROM and Flash Memory Versions (1) The memory map, the writing modes and programming circuits vary because of the differences in their internal memories. (2) The oscillation parameters of XIN-XOUT and XCIN-XCOUT may vary. (3) The QzROM version and the flash memory version MCUs differ in their manufacturing processes, built-in ROM, and layout patterns. Because of these differences, characteristic values, operation margins, A/D conversion accuracy, noise immunity, and noise radiation may vary within the specified range of electrical characteristics. (4) When switching from the flash memory version to the QzROM version, implement system evaluations equivalent to those implemented in the flash memory version. (5) The both operations except the electrical characteristics are same at the emulator (emulator MCU board: M38D59TRLFS). Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 11 of 134 38D5 Group FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION Central Processing Unit (CPU) The 38D5 Group uses the standard 740 Family instruction set. Refer to the 740 Family Software Manual for details on the instruction set. Machine-resident 740 Family instructions are as follows: The FST and SLW instructions cannot be used. The STP, WIT, MUL, and DIV instructions can be used. The central processing unit (CPU) has six registers. Figure 6 shows the 740 Family CPU register structure. [Accumulator (A)] The accumulator is an 8-bit register. Data operations such as arithmetic data transfer, etc., are executed mainly through the accumulator. [Index Register X (X)] The index register X is an 8-bit register. In the index addressing modes, the value of the OPERAND is added to the contents of register X and specifies the real address. [Index Register Y (Y)] The index register Y is an 8-bit register. In partial instruction, the value of the OPERAND is added to the contents of register Y and specifies the real address. b7 [Stack Pointer (S)] The stack pointer is an 8-bit register used during subroutine calls and interrupts. This register indicates start address of stored area (stack) for storing registers during subroutine calls and interrupts. The low-order 8 bits of the stack address are determined by the contents of the stack pointer. The high-order 8 bits of the stack address are determined by the stack page selection bit. If the stack page selection bit is “0”, the high-order 8 bits becomes “0016”. If the stack page selection bit is “1”, the high-order 8 bits becomes “0116”. The operations of pushing register contents onto the stack and popping them from the stack are shown in Figure 7. Table 7 shows the push and pop instructions of accumulator or processor status register. Store registers other than those described in Figure 7 with program when the user needs them during interrupts or subroutine calls. [Program Counter (PC)] The program counter is a 16-bit counter consisting of two 8-bit registers PCH and PCL. It is used to indicate the address of the next instruction to be executed. b0 A b7 Accumulator b0 X b7 Index register X b0 Y b7 Index register Y b0 S b15 b7 PCH Stack pointer b0 PCL Program counter b7 b0 N V T B D I Z C Processor status register (PS) Carry flag Zero flag Interrupt disable flag Decimal mode flag Break flag Index X mode flag Overflow flag Negative flag Fig. 6 740 Family CPU register structure Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 12 of 134 38D5 Group On-going Routine Interrupt request (1) → M(S) ← (PCH) Push return address on stack (S) ← (S) − 1 Execute JSR M(S) ← (PCL) M(S) ← (PCH) (S) ← (S) − 1 M(S) ← (PCL) ------------ Push return address on stack (S) ← (S) − 1 (S) ← (S) − 1 M(S) ← (PS) (S) ← (S) − 1 Push contents of processor status register on stack Interrupt Service Routine I Flag is set from “0” to “1” Fetch the jump vector Subroutine ..... Execute RTI Execute RTS (S) ← (S) + 1 (S) ← (S) + 1 (PS) ← M(S) POP return address from stack (PCL) ← M(S) POP contents of processor status register from stack (S) ← (S) + 1 (S) ← (S) + 1 (PCL) ← M(S) (PCH) ← M(S) (S) ← (S) + 1 POP return address from stack (PCH) ← M(S) Note1: Condition for acceptance of an interrupt request here → Interrupt disable flag is “0” and Interrupt enable bit corresponding to each interrupt source is “1” Fig. 7 Register push and pop at interrupt generation and subroutine call Table 7 Push and pop instructions of accumulator or processor status register Push instruction to stack PHA PHP Accumulator Processor status register Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 13 of 134 Pop instruction from stack PLA PLP 38D5 Group [Processor Status Register (PS)] The processor status register is an 8-bit register consisting of 5 flags which indicate the status of the processor after an arithmetic operation and 3 flags which decide MCU operation. Branch operations can be performed by testing the Carry (C) flag, Zero (Z) flag, Overflow (V) flag, or the Negative (N) flag. In decimal mode, the Z, V, N flags are not valid. • Bit 0: Carry flag (C) The C flag contains a carry or borrow generated by the arithmetic logic unit (ALU) immediately after an arithmetic operation. It can also be changed by a shift or rotate instruction. • Bit 1: Zero flag (Z) The Z flag is set to “1” if the result of an immediate arithmetic operation or a data transfer is “0”, and set to “0” if the result is anything other than “0”. • Bit 2: Interrupt disable flag (I) The I flag disables all interrupts except for the interrupt generated by the BRK instruction. Interrupts are disabled when the I flag is “1”. • Bit 3: Decimal mode flag (D) The D flag determines whether additions and subtractions are executed in binary or decimal. Binary arithmetic is executed when this flag is “0”; decimal arithmetic is executed when it is “1”. Decimal correction is automatic in decimal mode. Only the ADC and SBC instructions can be used for decimal arithmetic. Table 8 • Bit 4: Break flag (B) The B flag is used to indicate that the current interrupt was generated by the BRK instruction. When the BRK instruction is generated, the B flag is set to “1” automatically. When the other interrupts are generated, the B flag is set to “0”, and the processor status register is pushed onto the stack. • Bit 5: Index X mode flag (T) When the T flag is “0”, arithmetic operations are performed between accumulator and memory. When the T flag is “1”, direct arithmetic operations and direct data transfers are enabled between memory locations. • Bit 6: Overflow flag (V) The V flag is used during the addition or subtraction of one byte of signed data. It is set if the result exceeds +127 to -128. When the BIT instruction is executed, bit 6 of the memory location operated on by the BIT instruction is stored in the overflow flag. • Bit 7: Negative flag (N) The N flag is set to “1” if the result of an arithmetic operation or data transfer is negative. When the BIT instruction is executed, bit 7 of the memory location operated on by the BIT instruction is stored in the negative flag. Set and clear instructions of each bit of processor status register Set instruction Clear instruction C flag SEC CLC Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Z flag − − Page 14 of 134 I flag SEI CLI D flag SED CLD B flag − − T flag SET CLT V flag − CLV N flag − − 38D5 Group [CPU Mode Register (CPUM)] 003B16 The CPU mode register contains the stack page selection bit, etc. This register is allocated at address 003B16. After the system is released from reset, the mode depends on the OSCSEL pin state in the QzROM version. When the OSCSEL pin state is GND level, only the on-chip oscillator starts oscillation. The XIN -X OUT oscillation stops oscillating, and XCIN and XCOUT pins function as I/O ports. The operating mode is the on-chip oscillator mode. When the OSCSEL pin state is Vcc level, the X IN -X OUT oscillation divided by 8 starts oscillation. The on-chip oscillator stops oscillating, and the XCIN and XCOUT pins function as I/O ports. The operating mode is the frequency/8 mode. In the flash memory version, only the on-chip oscillator starts oscillating. The XIN-XOUT oscillation stops oscillating, and the XCIN and XCOUT pins function as I/O ports. The operating mode is the on-chip oscillator mode. When the main clock or sub-clock is used, after the XIN-XOUT oscillation and the XCIN-XCOUT oscillation are enabled, wait in the on-chip oscillator mode etc. until the oscillation stabilizes, and then switch the operation mode. When the main clock is not used (XIN-XOUT oscillation and an external clock input are not used), connect the XIN pin to VCC through a resistor and leave XOUT open. [CPU Mode Register 2 (CPUM2)] 001116 The CPU mode register 2 contains the control bits for the on-chip oscillator. The CPU mode register 2 is allocated at address 001116. CPU mode register 2 CPUM2 CM8 (address 001116, QzROM version, OSCSEL=L, initial value: 0016) ( QzROM version, OSCSEL=H, initial value: 0116) ( Flash memory version, initial value: 0016) b7 b0 On-chip oscillator stop bit (1) 0 : Oscillating 1 : Stopped Not used (do not write “1”) Not used (returns “0” when read) Not used (do not write “1”) CPU mode register CPUM CM7 CM6 CM5 CM4 CM3 CM2 CM1 CM0 (address 003B16, QzROM version, OSCSEL=L, initial value: E016) ( QzROM version, OSCSEL=H, initial value: 4016) ( Flash memory version, initial value: E016) b7 b0 Processor mode bits b1 b0 0 0 : Single-chip mode 0 1: 1 0 : Not available 1 1: Stack page selection bit 0 : 0 page 1 : 1 page Internal system clock selection bit 0 : Main clock selected (includes OCO, XIN) 1 : XCIN–XCOUT selected Port Xc switch bit (2) 0 : I/O port function (Oscillation stop) 1 : XCIN–XCOUT oscillating function XIN–XOUT oscillation stop bit (3) 0 : Oscillating 1 : Stopped Main clock division ratio selection bit (Valid only when CM3=0)(4) b7 b6 0 0 1 1 0 : f(XIN)/2 (frequency/2 mode) 1 : f(XIN)/8 (frequency/8 mode) 0 : f(XIN)/4 (frequency/4 mode) 1 : On-chip oscillator Notes 1: When the on-chip oscillator is selected by the watchdog timer count source selection bit 2 (bit 5 of watchdog timer control register (address 002916)), the on-chip oscillator does not stop even when the on-chip oscillator stop bit is set to “1”. Also, when the low-speed mode is set, the on-chip oscillator stops regardless of the value of this bit in the QzROM version. The on-chip oscillator does not stop in the flash memory version, so set this bit to “1” to stop the oscillation. In on-chip oscillator mode, even if this bit is set to “1”, the on-chip oscillator does not stop in the flash memory version, but stops in the QzROM version. 2: In low-speed mode, the XCIN-XCOUT oscillation stops if the port XC switch bit is set to “0”. 3: In XIN mode, the XIN-XOUT oscillation does not stop even if the XIN-XOUT oscillation stop bit is set to “1”. 4: 12.5 MHz < f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz is not available in the frequency/2 mode. Fig. 8 Structure of CPU mode register Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 15 of 134 38D5 Group <QzROM version> Reset OSCSEL ? H L Wait by operation until establishment Start with an on-chip oscillator. Initial value of CPUM is E016. Initial value of CPUM2 is 0016. As for the details of condition for transition among each mode, refer to the state transition of system clock. After releasing reset N Low-speed/XIN mode ? After releasing reset The CPU starts its operation in the built-in XIN mode. Initial value of CPUM is 4016. Initial value of CPUM2 is 0116. Y Oscillator starts oscillation. Do not change bit 3, bit 6 and bit 7 of CPUM until oscillation stabilizes. Start the oscillation (bits 4 and 5 of CPUM) Wait by on-chip oscillator operation until establishment of oscillator clock System can operate in on-chip oscillator mode until oscillation stabilize. Select internal system clock (bit 3 of CPUM or bit 7, 6 = “01”) Select internal system clock. Do not change bit 3, bit 6 and bit 7 of CPUM at the same time. Switch the main clock division ratio selection bit (bit 7, 6 = “00” or “10”) Select main clock division ratio. Switch to frequency/2 or frequency/4 mode here, if necessary. Main routine <Flash memory version> Reset Start with an on-chip oscillator. Initial value of CPUM is E016. Initial value of CPUM2 is 0016. As for the details of condition for transition among each mode, refer to the state transition of system clock. After releasing reset N Low-speed/XIN mode ? Y Oscillator starts oscillation. Do not change bit 3, bit 6 and bit 7 of CPUM until oscillation stabilizes. Start the oscillation (bits 4 and 5 of CPUM) Wait by on-chip oscillator operation until establishment of oscillator clock System can operate in on-chip oscillator mode until oscillation stabilize. Select internal system clock (bit 3 of CPUM or bit 7, 6 = “01”) Select internal system clock. Do not change bit 3, bit 6 and bit 7 of CPUM at the same time. Switch the main clock division ratio selection bit (bit 7, 6 = “00” or “10”) Select main clock division ratio. Switch to frequency/2 or 4 mode here, if necessary. Main routine Fig. 9 Switch procedure of CPU mode register Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 16 of 134 38D5 Group MEMORY • Special Function Register (SFR) Area The Special Function Register area in the zero page contains control registers such as I/O ports and timers. • RAM RAM is used for data storage and for stack area of subroutine calls and interrupts. • ROM In the QzROM version, the first 128 Kbytes and the last 2 bytes are reserved for device testing and the rest is the user area. Also, 1 byte of address FFDB16 is reserved. In the flash memory version, programming and erase operations can be performed to reserved ROM areas. • Interrupt Vector Area The interrupt vector area contains reset and interrupt vectors. • Zero Page Access to this area with only 2 bytes is possible in the zero page addressing mode. • Special Page Access to this area with only 2 bytes is possible in the special page addressing mode. • ROM Code Protect Address in QzROM Version (Address FFDB16) Address FFDB16 as reserved ROM area in the QzROM version is ROM code protect address. “0016” or “FE16” is written into this address when selecting the protect bit write by using a serial programmer and selecting protect enabled for writing shipment by Renesas Technology Corp. When “0016” or “FE16” is set to the ROM code protect address, the protect function is enabled, so that reading or writing from/to the corresponding area is disabled by a serial programmer. As for the QzROM product in blank, the ROM code is protected by selecting the protect bit write at ROM writing with a serial programmer. The protect can be performed, dividing twice. The protect area 1 is from the beginning address of ROM to address “EFFF16”. As for the QzROM product shipped after writing, “0016” (protect enabled to all area), “FE16” (protect enabled to the protect area 1) or “FF16” (protect disabled) is written into the ROM code protect address when Renesas Technology Corp. performs writing. The writing of “0016”, “FE16” or “FF16 ” can be selected as ROM option setup (“MASK option” written in the mask file converter) when ordering. For the ROM code protect in the flash memory version, refer to the “FLASH MEMORY MODE”. <Notes> • After a reset, the contents of RAM are undefined. Make sure to set the initial value before use. • When Renesas ships QzROM write products, we write ROM option data* specified by the mask file converter MM to the ROM code protect address. Therefore, set FF16 to the ROM code protect address in ROM data regardless of the presence or absence of a protect. When data other than FF16 is set, we may ask that the ROM data be submitted again. * ROM option data: mask option noted in MM Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 17 of 134 38D5 Group 000016 SFR area 004016 Zero page 010016 (2) RAM area RAM size (bytes) 192 256 384 512 640 768 896 1024 1536 2048 Address XXXX16 00FF16 013F16 01BF16 023F16 02BF16 033F16 03BF16 043F16 063F16 083F16 RAM XXXX16 Reserved area 084016 086316 0FE016 0FEF16 0FF016 LCD display RAM area Not used SFR area (1) SFR area 100016 ROM area ROM size (bytes) 4096 8192 12288 16384 20480 24576 28672 32768 36864 40960 45056 49152 53248 57344 61440 Address YYYY16 Address ZZZZ16 F00016 E00016 D00016 C00016 B00016 A00016 900016 800016 700016 600016 500016 400016 300016 200016 100016 F08016 E08016 D08016 C08016 B08016 A08016 908016 808016 708016 608016 508016 408016 308016 208016 108016 YYYY16 Reserved ROM area (128 bytes) Protect area 1 ZZZZ16 EFFF16 (2) ROM FF0016 FFD416 Reserved ROM area(1) FFDB16 Reserved ROM area (ID code) (ROM code protect) FFDC16 FFFE16 FFFF16 Special page Interrupt vector area Reserved ROM area Note 1: This area is available in the flash memory version only. 2: ROM correction vectors are assigned. As for the details, refer to the “ROM CORRECTION FUNCTION”. 3: In the flash memory version, programming and erase operations can be performed to reserved ROM areas. Note that their areas are different from those in the QzROM version. Fig. 10 Memory map diagram Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 18 of 134 38D5 Group 000016 Port P0 (P0) 002016 Timer 1 (T1) 000116 Port P0 direction register (P0D) 002116 Timer 2 (T2) 000216 Port P1 (P1) 002216 Timer 3 (T3) 000316 Port P1 direction register (P1D) 002316 Timer 4 (T4) 000416 Port P2 (P2) 002416 PWM01 register (PWM01) 000516 Port P2 direction register (P2D) 002516 Timer 12 mode register (T12M) 000616 Port P3 (P3) 002616 Timer 34 mode register (T34M) 000716 Port P3 direction register (P3D) 002716 Timer 1234 mode register (T1234M) 000816 Port P4 (P4) 002816 Timer 1234 frequency division selection register (PRE1234) 000916 Port P4 direction register (P4D) 002916 Watchdog timer control register (WDTCON) 000A16 Port P5 (P5) 002A16 Timer X (low-order) (TXL) 002B16 Timer X (high-order) (TXH) 000B16 Port P5 direction register (P5D) 000C16 Port P6 (P6) 000D16 Port P6 direction register (P6D) 000E16 Port P7 (P7) 000F16 Port P7 direction register (P7D) 002C16 Timer X (extension) (TXEX) 002D16 Timer X mode register (TXM) 002E16 Timer X control register 1 (TXCON1) 002F16 Timer X control register 2 (TXCON2) 003016 Compare register 1 (low-order) (COMP1L) 001116 CPU mode register 2 (CPUM2) 003116 Compare register 1 (high-order) (COMP1H) 001216 RRF register (RRFR) 003216 Compare register 2 (low-order) (COMP2L) 001316 LCD mode register1 (LM1) 003316 Compare register 2 (high-order) (COMP2H) 001416 LCD mode register2 (LM2) 003416 Compare register 3 (low-order) (COMP3L) 001516 AD control register (ADCON) 003516 Compare register 3 (high-order) (COMP3H) 001616 AD conversion register (low-order) (ADL) 003616 Timer Y (low-order) (TYL) 001716 AD conversion register (high-order) (ADH) 003716 Timer Y (high-order) (TYH) 001816 Transmit/receive buffer register 1 (TB1/RB1) 003816 Timer Y mode register (TYM) 001916 Serial I/O1 status register (SIO1STS) 003916 Timer Y control register (TYCON) 001016 001A16 Serial I/O1 control register (SIO1CON) 001B16 UART control register (UARTCON) 003A16 Interrupt edge selection register (INTEDGE) 001C16 Baud rate generator (BRG) 003C16 Interrupt request register 1 (IREQ1) 001D16 Serial I/O2 control register (SIO2CON) 003D16 Interrupt request register 2 (IREQ2) 001E16 Reserved (1) 003E16 Interrupt control register 1 (ICON1) 001F16 Serial I/O2 register (SIO2) 003F16 Interrupt control register 2 (ICON2) 0FE016 Flash memory control register 0 (FMCR0) 0FF016 PULL register 1 (PULL1) 0FE116 Flash memory control register 1 (FMCR1) 0FF116 PULL register 2 (PULL2) 0FE216 Flash memory control register 2 (FMCR2) 0FF216 PULL register 3 (PULL3) 0FE316 Reserved (1) 0FF316 Clock output control register (CKOUT) 0FE416 Reserved (1) 0FF416 Segment output disable register 0 (SEG0) 0FE516 Reserved (1) 0FF516 Segment output disable register 1 (SEG1) 0FE616 Reserved (1) 0FF616 Segment output disable register 2 (SEG2) 0FE716 Reserved (1) 0FF716 Key input control register (KIC) 0FE816 Reserved (1) 0FF816 ROM correction address 1 high-order register (RCA1H) 0FE916 Reserved (1) 0FF916 ROM correction address 1 low-order register (RCA1L) 0FEA16 Reserved (1) 0FFA16 ROM correction address 2 high-order register (RCA2H) 0FEB16 Reserved (1) 0FFB16 ROM correction address 2 low-order register (RCA2L) 003B16 CPU mode register (CPUM) 0FEC16 Reserved (1) 0FED16 Reserved (1) 0FFC16 ROM correction enable register (RCR) 0FEE16 Reserved (1) 0FFE16 Reserved (1) 0FEF16 Reserved (1) 0FFF16 Reserved (1) 0FFD16 Reserved (1) Note 1: The blanks are reserved. Do not write data to these areas. 2: No memory access is allowed to the blank areas within the SFRs. 3: Addresses 0FE016 to 0FEF16 are available in the flash memory version only. Fig. 11 Memory map of special function register (SFR) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 19 of 134 38D5 Group I/O PORTS • Direction Registers (Ports P0-P6, P72-P74) The I/O ports P0-P6, P7 2-P74 have direction registers which determine the input/output direction of each individual pin. Each bit in a direction register corresponds to one pin, each pin can be set to be input port or output port. When “0” is written to the bit of the direction register, the corresponding pin becomes an input pin. As for ports P0−P3, when “1” is written to the bit of the direction register and the segment output disable register, the corresponding pin becomes an output pin. As for ports P4−P6, P72-P74 when “1” is written to the bit of the direction register, the corresponding pin becomes an output pin. If data is read from a pin set to output, the value of the port latch is read, not the value of the pin itself. However, when peripheral output (RTP 1 , RTP 0 , T XOUT1 , T XOUT2 , T 4OUT, T 3OUT and T2OUT/CKOUT) is selected, the output value is read. Pins set to input are floating. If a pin set to input is written to, only the port output latch is written to and the pin remains floating. • Ports P70, P71 These are input ports which are shared with the voltage multiplier. When these are read out at using the voltage multiplier, the contents are “1”. • Pull-up Control Each individual bit of ports P0−P3 can be pulled up with a program by setting direction registers and segment output disable registers 0 to 2 (addresses 0FF416 to 0FF616). The pin is pulled up by setting “0” to the direction register and “1” to the segment output disable register. By setting the PULL registers (addresses 0FF016 to OFF216), ports P4−P7 can control pull-up with a program. However, the contents of PULL register do not affect ports programmed as the output ports. b7 Direction register “0” b7 b0 b7 b0 Input port No pull-up “1” 0 : No pull-up 1 : Pull-up PULL register 3 (PULL3 : address 0FF216)) P40-P43 pull-up 0 : No pull-up P44-P47 pull-up 1 : Pull-up P72-P74 pull-up Not used (do not write “1”) Not used (return “0” when read) b7 b0 Segment output disable register 0 (SEG0 : address 0FF416) P00 pull-up P01 pull-up P02 pull-up P03 pull-up P04 pull-up P05 pull-up P06 pull-up P07 pull-up b0 0 : No pull-up 1 : Pull-up Segment output disable register 1 (SEG1 : address 0FF516) P20 pull-up P21 pull-up P22 pull-up P23 pull-up “1” P24 pull-up P25 pull-up P26 pull-up P27 pull-up Input port Pull-up b7 Segment output 0 : No pull-up 1 : Pull-up PULL register 2 (PULL2 : address 0FF116)) P60 pull-up P61 pull-up P62 pull-up P63 pull-up P64 pull-up P65 pull-up P66 pull-up P67 pull-up Initial state “0” PULL register 1 (PULL1 : address 0FF0 16) P50 pull-up P51 pull-up P52 pull-up P53 pull-up P54 pull-up P55 pull-up P56 pull-up P57 pull-up b7 Segment output disable register b0 Port output Fig. 12 Structure of ports P0 to P3 b0 0 : No pull-up 1 : Pull-up Segment output disable register 2 (SEG2 : address 0FF616) P10-P13 pull-up P14-P17 pull-up 0 : No pull-up P30-P33 pull-up 1 : Pull-up P34-P37 pull-up Not used (do not write “1”) Note1: The PULL register and segment output disable register affect only ports programmed as the input ports. Fig. 13 Structure of PULL register and segment output disable register Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 20 of 134 38D5 Group Table 9 List of I/O port function Pin Name P00/SEG8− P07/SEG15 Port P0 P10/SEG16− P17/SEG23 P20/SEG0/(KW4)− P23/SEG3/(KW7) Input/Output I/O format Non-port function Related SFRs Ref. No. Input/Output, CMOS compatible input level LCD segment output individual bits CMOS 3-state output Segment output disable register 0 (1) Port P1 Input/Output, CMOS compatible input level individual bits CMOS 3-state output Segment output disable register 2 Port P2 Input/Output, CMOS compatible input level individual bits CMOS 3-state output Key input (key-on wakeup) interrupt input P24/SEG4− P27/SEG7 Segment output disable register 1 Key input control register (2) Segment output disable register 1 (1) P30/SEG24− P37/SEG31 Port P3 Input/Output, CMOS compatible input level individual bits CMOS 3-state output Segment output disable register 2 P40/RXD P41/TXD P42/SCLK1, Port P4 Input/Output, CMOS compatible input level Serial I/O1 function I/O individual bits CMOS 3-state output PULL register 3 (3) Serial I/O1 control register (4) P43/SRDY1 P44/SIN2/(KW0) P45/SOUT2/(KW1) P46/SCLK2/(KW2) P47/SRDY2/(KW3) P50/AN0/RTP0 P51/AN1/RTP1 Serial I/O2 function I/O Port P5 Input/Output, CMOS compatible input level A/D individual bits CMOS 3-state output conversion input Key input (key-on wakeup) interrupt input (5) UART control register (6) PULL register 3 (7) Serial I/O2 control register (8) Serial I/O2 register (9) Key input control register (10) PULL register 1 Real time port function AD control register Timer Y mode register output P52/AN2− P56/AN6 PULL register 1 AD control register P57/AN7/ADKEY0 P60/XCIN P61/XCOUT Serial I/O1 status register Input/Output, CMOS compatible input level Sub-clock individual bits CMOS 3-state output oscillation circuit (12) (13) ADKEY input Port P6 (11) PULL register 2 CPU mode register (14) (15) P62/INT00/(LED0) External interrupt input PULL register 2 Interrupt edge selection register (16) P63/TXOUT2/(LED1) Timer X output 2 PULL register 2 Timer X mode register Timer X control registers 1,2 (18) P64/INT2/(LED2) External interrupt input PULL register 2 Interrupt edge selection register (17) P65/TXOUT1/(LED3) Timer X output 1 PULL register 2 Timer X mode register Timer X control register 1 (18) P66/INT10/CNTR0/ (LED4) Timer X function input External interrupt input PULL register 2 Interrupt edge selection register Timer X mode register Timer X control registers 1,2 (19) P67/CNTR1/(LED5) Timer Y function input PULL register 2 Timer Y mode register (17) Input, CMOS compatible input level External interrupt input individual bits LCD voltage multiplier input Interrupt edge selection register LCD mode registers 1,2 (20) Input/Output CMOS compatible input level Timer 2 individual bits CMOS 3-state output output clock output (21) Timer 3 output Timer 4 output PWM output PULL register 3 Timer 1234 mode register Timer 1234 frequency division register Clock output control register LCD mode register 1,2 (22) P70/C1/INT01 P71/C2/INT11 Port P7 P72/T2OUT/ CKOUT P73/PWM0/T3OUT P74/PWM1/T4OUT COM0 −COM3 Common Output LCD common output COM4/SEG35− COM7/SEG32 Common /Segment LCD common/Segment output Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 21 of 134 LCD common output LCD Segment output (23) 38D5 Group (1) Ports P0, P1, P24-P27, P3 (2) Ports P20-P23 VL3/VL2 VL3/VL2 Segment data Segment data VL1/VSS Segment output disable bit VL1/VSS Segment output disable bit Direction register Data bus Direction register Data bus Port latch Port latch Key-on wakeup interrupt input Key input control (4) Port P41 (3) Port P40 Pull-up control Pull-up control Serial I/O enable bit Receive enable bit P41/TxD P-channel output disable bit Serial I/O1 enable bit Transmit enable bit Direction register Data bus Direction register Data bus Port latch Serial I/O input Port latch Serial I/O output (5) Port P42 (6) Port P43 Serial I/O1 synchronous clock selection bit Serial I/O1 enable bit Serial I/O1 mode selection bit Serial I/O1 enable bit Pull-up control Serial I/O1 mode selection bit Serial I/O1 enable bit SRDY1 output enable bit Direction register Direction register Data bus Data bus Port latch Port latch Serial I/O1 ready output Serial I/O1 clock output Serial I/O1 clock input Fig. 14 Port block diagram (1) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 22 of 134 Pull-up control 38D5 Group (7) Port P44 (8) Port P45 P45/SOUT2 P-channel output disable bit Serial I/O2 transmit end signal Serial I/O2 synchronous clock selection bit Serial I/O2 port selection bit Pull-up control Direction register Data bus Pull-up control Direction register Data bus Port latch Port latch Serial I/O2 input Serial I/O2 input Key input control Key-on wakeup interrupt input (9) Port P46 Key input control Key-on wakeup interrupt input (10) Port P47 Pull-up control Pull-up control Serial I/O2 synchronous clock selection bit Serial I/O2 port selection bit SRDY2 output selection bit Direction register Direction register Data bus Data bus Port latch Serial I/O2 clock output Port latch Serial I/O2 ready output Serial I/O2 input Key input control Key-on wakeup interrupt input (11) Ports P50, P51 (12) Ports P52-P56 Pull-up control Pull-up control Direction register Direction register Data bus Key input control Key-on wakeup interrupt input Port latch Data bus Port latch Real time port control bit Data for real time port ADKEY enable bit Analog input pin selection bit A/D conversion input Fig. 15 Port block diagram (2) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 23 of 134 ADKEY enable bit Analog input pin selection bit A/D conversion input 38D5 Group (13) Port P57 (14) Port P60 Pull-up control Pull-up control Port Xc switch bit Port Xc switch bit Direction register Data bus Direction register Port latch Data bus Port latch ADKEY selection bit Sub-clock oscillation circuit input ADKEY enable bit Analog input pin selection bit A/D conversion input (15) Port P61 (16) Port P62 Pull-up control Pull-up control Port Xc switch bit Port Xc switch bit Direction register Data bus Direction register Data bus Port latch Port latch Sub-clock oscillation circuit Port P60 INT0 interrupt input INT0 input port switch bit Xc oscillation enable (17) Ports P64, P67 (18) Ports P63, P65 Pull-up control Pull-up control Direction register Direction register Data bus Port latch Data bus CNTR1 interrupt input INT2 interrupt input Fig. 16 Port block diagram (3) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 24 of 134 Port latch Pulse output mode Timer X output 1 Timer X output 2 38D5 Group (20) Ports P70, P71 (19) Port P66 Pull-up control C1,C2 Direction register Voltage multiplier control bit Data bus Data bus Port latch INT0 interrupt INT1 interrupt INT0 input port switch bit INT1 input port switch bit CNTR0 interrupt input INT1 interrupt input INT1 input port switch bit (22) COM0 to COM3 (21) Ports P72, P73, P74 VL3 Pull-up control Data bus The gate input signal of each transistor is controlled by the LCD duty ratio and the bias value. VL2 Direction register VL1 Port latch VSS Port/Timer output selected Timer output/PWM output Timer output/system clock φ output/XCIN output (23) COM4/SEG35 to COM7/SEG32 VL3 VL2 VL1 The gate input signal of each transistor is controlled by the LCD duty ratio and the bias value. VL2/VL3 VSS Duty ratio selection bits Segment data VL1/VSS Fig. 17 Port block diagram (4) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 25 of 134 38D5 Group • Termination of unused pins • Termination of common pins I/O ports: Select an input port or an output port and follow each processing method. In addition, it is recommended that related registers be overwritten periodically to prevent malfunctions, etc. Output ports: Open. Input ports: If the input level become unstable, through current flow to an input circuit, and the power supply current may increase. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 26 of 134 Especially, when expecting low consumption current (at STP or WIT instruction execution etc.), pull-up or pull-down input ports to prevent through current (built-in resistor can be used). We recommend processing unused pins through a resistor which can secure IOH(avg) or IOL(avg). Because, when an I/O port or a pin which have an output function is selected as an input port, it may operate as an output port by incorrect operation etc. 38D5 Group Table 10 Termination of unused pins Pin P00/SEG8−P07/SEG15 Termination 1 Termination 2 Termination 3 When selecting SEG output, open. − P40/RXD When selecting RxD function, perform termination of input port. − P41/TXD When selecting TxD function, perform termination of output port. − P42/SCLK1 When selecting external clock input, perform termination of input port. P43/SRDY1 When selecting SRDY1 function, perform termination of output port. − P44/SIN2/(KW0) When selecting SIN2 function, perform termination of input port. − P45/SOUT2/(KW1) When selecting SOUT2 function, perform termination of output port. − P46/SCLK2/(KW2) When selecting external clock input, perform termination of output port. P47/SRDY2/(KW3) When selecting SRDY2 function, perform termination of output port. − P50/AN0/RTP0 P51/AN1/RTP1 When selecting AN function, these pins can be opened. (A/D conversion result cannot be guaranteed.) When selecting RTP function, perform termination of output port. I/O port P10/SEG16−P17/SEG23 P20/SEG0/(KW4)− P27/SEG7 P30/SEG24−P37/SEG31 P52/AN2−P56/AN6 P57/AN7/ADKEY0 When selecting internal clock output, perform termination of output port. When selecting internal clock output, perform termination of output port. − When selecting ADKEY function, pull-up this pin through a resistor. P60/XCIN P61/XCOUT Do not select XCIN−XCOUT oscillation function by program. − P62/INT00/(LED0) When selecting INT function, perform termination of input port. − P63/TXOUT2/(LED1) When selecting TXOUT function, perform termination of output port. − P64/INT2/(LED2) When selecting INT function, perform termination of input port. − P65/TXOUT1/(LED3) When selecting TXOUT function, perform termination of output port. − P66/INT10/CNTR0/ (LED4) When selecting CNTR input function or INT function, perform termination of input port. − P67/CNTR1/(LED5) When selecting CNTR input function, perform termination of input port. − P70/C1/INT01 P71/C2/INT11 Disable the voltage multiplier, and When selecting INT function, disable the voltage connect to VSS through a resistor. multiplier, and connect to VSS through a resistor. − P72/T2OUT/CKOUT I/O port When selecting T2OUT function or CKOUT function, perform termination of output port. − When selecting PWM, T3OUT, or T4OUT function, perform termination of output port. − VL3 Set the VL3 connect bit to “1” and Set the VL3 connect bit to “0” and leave the apply a Vcc level voltage to VL3 pin. VL3 pin open. − P73/PWM0/T3OUT P74/PWM1/T4OUT VL2 VL3 ≥ VL2 ≥ VL1 − − VL1 Connect to VSS − − COM0−COM3 Open − − COM4/SEG35− COM7/SEG32 Open − − VREF Connect to VCC − − XIN When only on-chip oscillator is used, connect to VCC through a resistor. − − XOUT When external clock is input or when only on-chip oscillator is used, open. − − Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 27 of 134 38D5 Group INTERRUPTS The 38D5 Group interrupts are vector interrupts with a fixed priority scheme, and generated by 16 sources among 17 sources: 6 external, 10 internal, and 1 software. The interrupt sources, vector addresses(1), and interrupt priority are shown in Table 11. Each interrupt except the BRK instruction interrupt has the interrupt request bit and the interrupt enable bit. These bits and the interrupt disable flag (I flag) control the acceptance of interrupt requests. Figure 18 shows an interrupt control diagram. Table 11 An interrupt requests is accepted when all of the following conditions are satisfied: • Interrupt disable flag ................................ “0” • Interrupt request bit .................................. “1” • Interrupt enable bit ................................... “1” Though the interrupt priority is determined by hardware, priority processing can be performed by software using the above bits and flag. Interrupt vector addresses and priority Interrupt Source Priority Vector Addresses(1) High Low Interrupt Request Generating Conditions Remarks Reset(2) 1 FFFD16 FFFC16 At reset Non-maskable INT0 (INT00 or INT01)(3) 2 FFFB16 FFFA16 At detection of either rising or falling edge of INT0 input External interrupt (active edge selectable) INT1 (INT10 or INT11)(3) 3 FFF916 FFF816 At detection of either rising or falling edge of INT1 input External interrupt (active edge selectable) INT2 4 FFF716 FFF616 At detection of either rising or falling edge of INT2 input Valid when INT2 interrupt is selected External interrupt (active edge selectable) Key input (key-on wakeup) 5 FFF516 FFF416 At falling of ports P20−P23, P44−P47 input logical level AND Valid when Key input interrupt is selected External interrupt (falling valid) Timer X 6 FFF316 FFF216 At timer X underflow Timer 1 7 FFF116 FFF016 At timer 1 underflow Timer 2 8 FFEF16 FFEE16 At timer 2 underflow Timer 3 9 FFED16 FFEC16 At timer 3 underflow Timer 4 10 FFEB16 FFEA16 At timer 4 underflow Serial I/O1 receive 11 FFE916 FFE816 At completion of serial I/O1 data receive Valid only when serial I/O1 is selected Serial I/O1 transmit 12 FFE716 FFE616 At completion of serial I/O1 transmit shift or transmit buffer is empty Serial I/O2 13 FFE516 FFE416 At completion of serial I/O2 data transmit/receive CNTR0 14 FFE316 FFE216 At detection of either rising or falling edge of CNTR0 input Timer Y 15 FFE116 FFE016 At timer Y underflow At detection of either rising or falling edge of CNTR1 input CNTR1 A/D conversion 16 FFDF16 FFDE16 At completion of A/D conversion BRK instruction 17 FFDD16 FFDC16 At BRK instruction execution Valid only when serial I/O1 is selected External interrupt (active edge selectable) External interrupt (active edge selectable) Non-maskable software interrupt NOTES: 1. Vector addresses contain interrupt jump destination addresses. 2. Reset function in the same way as an interrupt with the highest priority. 3. INT0, and INT1 input pins are selected by the interrupt edge selection register (INTEDGE). Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 28 of 134 38D5 Group Interrupt request bit Interrupt enable bit Interrupt disable flag (I) BRK instruction Reset Interrupt acceptance Fig. 18 Interrupt control • Interrupt Disable Flag The interrupt disable flag is assigned to bit 2 of the processor status register. This flag controls the acceptance of all interrupt requests except for the BRK instruction. When this flag is set to “1”, the acceptance of interrupt requests is disabled. When it is set to “0”, acceptance of interrupt requests is enabled. This flag is set to “1” with the SEI instruction and set to “0” with the CLI instruction. When an interrupt request is accepted, the contents of the processor status register are pushed onto the stack while the interrupt disable flag remains set to “0”. Subsequently, this flag is automatically set to “1” and multiple interrupts are disabled. To use multiple interrupts, set this flag to “0” with the CLI instruction within the interrupt processing routine. The contents of the processor status register are popped off the stack with the RTI instruction. • Interrupt Request Bits Once an interrupt request is generated, the corresponding interrupt request bit is set to “1” and remains “1” until the request is accepted . Wh en the request is accepted, th is bit is automatically set to “0”. Each interrupt request bit can be set to “0”, but cannot be set to “1”, by software. • Interrupt Enable Bits The interrupt enable bits control the acceptance of the corresponding interrupt requests. When an interrupt enable bit is set to “0”, the acceptance of the corresponding interrupt request is disabled. If an interrupt request occurs in this condition, the corresponding interrupt request bit is set to “1”, but the interrupt request is not accepted. When an interrupt enable bit is set to “1”, acceptance of the corresponding interrupt request is enabled. Each interrupt enable bit can be set to “0” or “1” by software. The interrupt enable bit for an unused interrupt should be set to “0”. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 29 of 134 • Interrupt Source Selection Any of the following combinations can be selected by the interrupt edge selection register (003A16). • Timer Y or CNTR1 • External Interrupt Pin Selection For external interrupts INT0 and INT1, the INT0, INT1 input port switch bit in the interrupt edge selection register (bits 4 and 5 of address 003A16) can be used to select INT00 and INT01 pin input or INT10 and INT11 pin input. 38D5 Group b7 b0 Interrupt edge selection register (INTEDGE : address 003A16) INT0 interrupt edge selection bit INT1 interrupt edge selection bit INT2 interrupt edge selection bit Timer Y/CNTR1 interrupt switch bit 0 : Timer Y interrupt 1 : CNTR1 interrupt INT0 input port switch bit 0 : input from Port P62 (INT00) 1 : input from Port P70 (INT01) INT1 input port switch bit 0 : input from Port P66 (INT10) 1 : input from Port P71 (INT11) Not used (do not write to “1”) Not used (return “0” when read) b7 b0 Interrupt request register 1 (IREQ1 : address 003C16) 0 : Falling edge active 1 : Rising edge active b7 b0 Interrupt request register 2 (IREQ2 : address 003D16) Timer 4 interrupt request bit Serial I/O1 receive interrupt request bit Serial I/O1 transmit interrupt request bit Serial I/O2 receive/transmit interrupt request bit CNTR0 interrupt request bit Timer Y interrupt request bit CNTR1 interrupt request bit AD conversion interrupt request bit Not used (returns “0” when read) INT0 interrupt request bit INT1 interrupt request bit INT2 interrupt request bit Key input interrupt request bit Timer X interrupt request bit Timer 1 interrupt request bit Timer 2 interrupt request bit Timer 3 interrupt request bit 0 : No interrupt request issued 1 : Interrupt request issued b7 b0 b7 Interrupt control register 1 (ICON1 : address 003E16) INT0 interrupt enable bit INT1 interrupt enable bit INT2 interrupt enable bit Key input interrupt enable bit Timer X interrupt enable bit Timer 1 interrupt enable bit Timer 2 interrupt enable bit Timer 3 interrupt enable bit Fig. 19 Structure of interrupt-related registers Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 30 of 134 b0 Interrupt control register 2 (ICON2 : address 003F16) Timer 4 interrupt enable bit Serial I/O1 receive interrupt enable bit Serial I/O1 transmit interrupt enable bit Serial I/O2 receive/transmit interrupt enable bit CNTR0 interrupt enable bit Timer Y interrupt enable bit CNTR1 interrupt enable bit AD conversion interrupt enable bit Not used (do not write to “1”) 0 : Interrupts disabled 1 : Interrupts enabled 38D5 Group • Interrupt Request Generation, Acceptance, and Handling Interrupts have the following three phases. (i) Interrupt Request Generation An interrupt request is generated by an interrupt source (external interrupt signal input, timer underflow, etc.) and the corresponding request bit is set to “1”. (ii) Interrupt Request Acceptance Based on the interrupt acceptance timing in each instruction cycle, the interrupt control circuit determines acceptance conditions (interrupt request bit, interrupt enable bit, and interrupt disable flag) and interrupt priority levels for accepting interrupt requests. When two or more interrupt requests are generated simultaneously, the highest priority interrupt is accepted. The value of interrupt request bit for an unaccepted interrupt remains the same and acceptance is determined at the next interrupt acceptance timing point. (iii) Handling of Accepted Interrupt Request The accepted interrupt request is processed. Figure 20 shows the time up to execution in the interrupt routine, and Figure 21 shows the interrupt sequence. Figure 22 shows the timing of interrupt request generation, interrupt request bit, and interrupt request acceptance. Interrupt request generated Interrupt request acceptance Interrupt routine starts Interrupt sequence Stack push and Vector fetch Main routine * 0 to 16 cycles Interrupt handling routine 7 cycles 7 to 23 cycles * When executing DIV instruction Fig. 20 Time up to execution in interrupt routine Push onto stack Vector fetch Execute interrupt routine φ SYNC RD • Interrupt Handling Execution When interrupt handling is executed, the following operations are performed automatically. (1) Once the currently executing instruction is completed, an interrupt request is accepted. (2) The contents of the program counters and the processor status register at this point are pushed onto the stack area in order from 1 to 3. 1. High-order bits of program counter (PCH) 2. Low-order bits of program counter (PCL) 3. Processor status register (PS) (3) Concurrently with the push operation, the jump address of the corresponding interrupt (the start address of the interrupt processing routine) is transferred from the interrupt vector to the program counter. (4) The interrupt request bit for the corresponding interrupt is set to “0”. Also, the interrupt disable flag is set to “1” and multiple interrupts are disabled. (5) The interrupt routine is executed. (6) When the RTI instruction is executed, the contents of the registers pushed onto the stack area are popped off in the order from 3 to 1. Then, the routine that was before running interrupt processing resumes. As described above, it is necessary to set the stack pointer and the jump address in the vector area corresponding to each interrupt to execute the interrupt processing routine. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 31 of 134 WR Address bus Data bus PC Not used S,SPS S-1,SPS S-2,SPS PCH PCL PS BL BH AL AL,AH AH SYNC : CPU operation code fetch cycle (This is an internal signal that cannot be observed from the external unit.) BL, BH: Vector address of each interrupt AL, AH: Jump destination address of each interrupt SPS : “0016” or “0116” ([SPS] is a page selected by the stack page selection bit of CPU mode register.) Fig. 21 Interrupt sequence 38D5 Group <Notes> The interrupt request bit may be set to “1” in the following cases. • When setting the external interrupt active edge Related bits: INT0 interrupt edge selection bit (bit 0 of interrupt edge selection register (address 003A16)) INT1 interrupt edge selection bit (bit 1 of interrupt edge selection register) INT2 interrupt edge selection bit (bit 2 of interrupt edge selection register) CNTR0 activate edge switch bit (bits 6 and 7 of timer X control register 1 (address 002E16)) CNTR1 activate edge switch bit (bits 6 of timer Y mode register (address 003816)) • When switching the interrupt sources of an interrupt vector address where two or more interrupt sources are assigned Related bit: Timer Y/CNTR1 interrupt switch bit (bit 3 of interrupt edge selection register) • When switching the INT pins Related bits: INT0 input port switch bit (bit 4 of interrupt edge selection register) INT1 input port switch bit (bit 5 of interrupt edge selection register) If it is not necessary to generate an interrupt synchronized with these settings, take the following sequence. (1) Set the corresponding enable bit to “0” (disabled). (2) Set the interrupt edge selection bit (the active edge switch bit) or the interrupt source bit. (3) Set the corresponding interrupt request bit to “0” after one or more instructions have been executed. (4) Set the corresponding interrupt enable bit to “1” (enabled). Push onto stack Vector fetch Instruction cycle Instruction cycle Internal clock φ SYNC 1 T1 2 IR1 T2 IR2 T3 T1 T2 T3 : Interrupt acceptance timing points IR1 IR2 : Timings points at which the interrupt request bit is set to “1”. Note : Period 2 indicates the last φ cycle during one instruction cycle. (1) The interrupt request bit for an interrupt request generated during period 1 is set to “1” at timing point IR1. (2) The interrupt request bit for an interrupt request generated during period 2 is set to “1” at timing point IR1 or IR2. The timing point at which the bit is set to “1” varies depending on conditions. When two or more interrupt requests are generated during the period 2, each request bit may be set to “1” at timing point IR1 or IR2 separately. Fig. 22 Timing of interrupt request generation, interrupt request bit, and interrupt acceptance Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 32 of 134 38D5 Group • Key Input Interrupt (Key-on Wake-Up) A key input interrupt request is generated by detecting the falling edge from any pin of ports P20−P23, P44−P47 that have been set to input mode. In other words, it is generated when AND of input level goes from “1” to “0”. An example of using a key input interrupt is shown in Figure 23, where an interrupt request is generated by pressing one of the keys consisted as an active-low key matrix which inputs to ports P44−P47. Port PXx “L” level output Port P2 direction register bit 3 = “1” Key input control register bit 7 = “1” Port P23 latch Segment output disable register 1 Bit 3 = “1” ∗ ∗∗ Key input interrupt request P23 output Segment output disable register 1 Bit 2 = “1” ∗ ∗∗ Port P22 direction register bit 2 = “1” Key input control register bit 6 = “1” Port P22 latch P22 output Port P2 direction register bit 1 = “1” Key input control register bit 5 = “1” Port P21 latch Segment output disable register 1 Bit 1 = “1” ∗ ∗∗ Port P2 Input reading circuit P21 output Segment output disable register 1 Bit 0 = “1” ∗ ∗∗ Port P2 direction register bit 0 = “1” Key input control register bit 4 = “1” Port P20 latch P20 output ∗ P47 input ∗ Port P4 direction register bit 7 = “0” Key input control register bit 3 = “1” Port P47 ∗∗ latch Port P4 direction register bit 6 = “0” Key input control register bit 2 = “1” Port P46 ∗∗ latch P46 input Port P4 direction register bit 5 = “0” ∗ ∗∗ Port P45 latch Key input control register bit 1 = “1” Port P4 Input reading circuit P45 input Port P4 direction register bit 4 = “0” ∗ ∗∗ Port P44 latch Key input control register bit 0 = “1” P44 input PULL register 3 Bit 1 = “1” ∗ P-channel transistor for pull-up ∗∗ CMOS output buffer Fig. 23 Connection example when using key input interrupt Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 33 of 134 38D5 Group A key input interrupt is controlled by the key input control register and port direction registers. When the key input interrupt is enabled, set “1” to the key input control register. A key input of any pin of ports P20−P23, P44−P47 that have been set to input mode is accepted. b7 b0 Key input control register (KIC : address 0FF716) P44 key input control bit P45 key input control bit P46 key input control bit P47 key input control bit P20 key input control bit P21 key input control bit P22 key input control bit P23 key input control bit 0 : Key input interrupt disabled 1 : Key input interrupt enabled Fig. 24 Structure of key input control register Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 34 of 134 38D5 Group TIMERS 8-Bit Timer The 38D5 Group has four built-in 8-bit timers: Timer 1, Timer 2, Timer 3, and Timer 4. Timer 1 Timer 2 Timer 3 Timer 4 (1) φ SOURCE Frequency divider 8 Each timer has the 8-bit timer latch. All timers are downcounters. When the timer reaches “0016”, the contents of the timer latch is reloaded into the timer with the next count pulse. In this mode, the interrupt request bit corresponding to that timer is set to “1”. The count can be stopped by setting the stop bit of each timer to “1”. Frequency division selection bits (2 bits for each Timer) Data bus Clock for Timer 4 Clock for Timer 3 Clock for Timer 2 Clock for Timer 1 XCIN Timer 1 count source selection “00” bits “01” Clock for Timer 1 The following values can be selected the clock for Timer; 1/1, 1/2, 1/16, 1/256 Timer 1 latch (8) Timer 1 (8) “10” Timer Y output Timer 1 interrupt request Timer 1 count stop bit P72 clock output control bit “10” XCIN System clock φ P72 direction register Timer 2 latch (8) “01” Clock for Timer 2 “01” P72/T2OUT/CKOUT Timer 2 count source selection bits “00” Timer 2 (8) “10” Timer 2 output selection bit Timer 2 write control bit Timer 2 interrupt request Timer 2 count stop bit “00” S “0” Q T 1/2 “1” Q T2OUT output edge switch bit P72 latch Timer 2 output selection bit Timer 3 count source selection bit “1” Clock for Timer 3 Timer 3 operating mode selection bit P73/PWM0/ T3OUT Timer 3 latch (8) Timer 3 (8) Timer 3 write control bit Timer 3 interrupt request Timer 3 count stop bit “0” 10 bit PWM0 circuit “1” Timer 3 output selection bit PWM01 register (2) “0” “0” S Q P73 direction P73 T “1” register latch Q 1/2 3OUT output T Timer 3 output selection bit edge switch bit “01” “10” Clock for Timer 4 Timer 4 operating mode selection bit P74/PWM1/ T4OUT “1” 10 bit PWM1 circuit “00” Timer 4 count source selection bits Timer 4 latch (8) Timer 4 (8) “11” Timer 4 count stop bit f(XIN) Timer 4 output selection bit PWM01 register (2) “0” “0” S Q P74 P74 direction T “1” latch register 1/2 Q T4OUT output Timer 4 output selection bit edge switch bit Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode Fig. 25 Timer 1-4 block diagram Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 35 of 134 Timer 4 write control bit Timer 4 interrupt request 38D5 Group • Frequency Divider For Timer Timer 1, timer 2, timer 3 and timer 4 have the frequency divider for the count source. The count source of the frequency divider is switched to XIN, XCIN, or the on-chip oscillator OCO divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode by the CPU mode register. The frequency divider is controlled by each timer division ratio selection bit. The division ratio can be selected from as follows; 1/1, 1/2, 1/16, 1/256 of f(XIN), f(XCIN) or f(OCO)/4. Switch the frequency division or count source* while the timer count is stopped. *This also applies when the frequency divider output is selected as the timer count source and the count source is switched in conjunction with a transition between operating modes (onchip oscillator mode, XIN mode, or low-speed mode). Be careful when changing settings in the CPU mode register. • Timer 1, Timer 2 The count source for timer 1 and timer 2 can be set using the timer 12 mode register. X CIN may be selected as the count source. If XCIN is selected, count operation is possible regardless of whether or not the XIN input oscillator or the on-chip oscillator is operating. In addition, the timer 12 mode register can be used to output from the P72/T2OUT pin a signal to invert the polarity every time timer 2 underflows. At reset, all bits of the timer 12 mode register are set to “0”, timer 1 is set to “FF16”, and timer 2 is set to “0116”. When executing the STP instruction, previously set the wait time at return. • Timer 3, Timer 4 The count sources of timer 3 and timer 4 can be selected by setting the timer 34 mode register. Also, by the timer 34 mode register, each time timer 3 or timer 4 underflows, the signal of which polarity is inverted can be output from P73/T3OUT pin or P74/T4OUT pin. • Timer 3 PWM0 Mode, Timer 4 PWM1 Mode A PWM rectangular waveform corresponding to the 10-bit accuracy can be output from the P73/PWM0 pin and P74/PWM1 pin by setting the timer 34 mode register and PWM01 register (refer to Figure 26). One output pulse is the short interval. Four output pulses are the long interval. The “n” is the value set in the timer 3 (address 002216) or the timer 4 (address 002316). The “ts” is one period of timer 3 or timer 4 count source. “H” width of the short interval is obtained by n × ts. However, in the long interval, “H” width of output pulse is extended for ts which is set by the PWM01 register (address 002416). <Notes on Timer 1 to Timer 4> (1) Timer 3 PWM0 Mode, Timer 4 PWM1 Mode • When PWM output is suspended after starting PWM output, depending on the level of the output pulse at that time to resume an output, the delay of the one section of the short interval may be needed. Stop at “H”: No output delay Stop at “L”: Output is delayed time of 256 × ts • In the PWM mode, the follows are performed every cycle of the long interval (4 × 256 × ts). • Generation of timer 3, timer 4 interrupt requests • Update of timer 3, timer 4 (2) Write to Timer 2, Timer 3, Timer 4 When writing to the latch only, if the write timing to the reload latch and the underflow timing are almost the same, the value is set into the timer and the timer latch at the same time. In this time, counting is stopped during writing to the reload latch. Output waveform of Timer 3 PWM0 or Timer 4 PWM1 Long interval 4 × 256 × ts Short interval 256 × ts PWM01 register = “002” PWM01 register = “012” PWM01 register = “102” PWM01 register = “112” Short interval 256 × ts Short interval 256 × ts Short interval 256 × ts n × ts n × ts n × ts n × ts (n+1) × ts n × ts n × ts n × ts (n+1) × ts n × ts (n+1) × ts n × ts (n+1) × ts (n+1) × ts (n+1) × ts n × ts Interrupt request Interrupt request n: Setting value of Timer 3 or Timer 4 ts: One period of Timer 3 count source or Timer 4 count source PWM01 register (address 002416) : 2-bit value corresponding to PWM0 (bits 0, 1) or PWM1 (bits 2, 3) Fig. 26 Waveform of PWM0 and PWM1 Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 36 of 134 38D5 Group b7 b7 b0 b0 Timer 12 mode register (T12M: address 002516) PWM01 register (PWM01: address 002416) Timer 1 count stop bit 0 : Count operation 1 : Count stop PWM0 set bits b1b0 0 0 1 1 Timer 2 count stop bit 0 : Count operation 1 : Count stop PWM1 set bits Timer 1 count source selection bits b3b2 b3b2 0 0 1 1 0 : No extended 1 : Extended once in four periods 0 : Extended twice in four periods 1 : Extended three times in four periods 0 0 1 1 0 : Frequency divider for Timer 1 1 : f(XCIN) 0 : Underflow of Timer Y 1 : Not available 0 : No extended 1 : Extended once in four periods 0 : Extended twice in four periods 1 : Extended three times in four periods Not used (returns “0” when read) Timer 2 count source selection bits b5b4 0 0 1 1 0 : Underflow of Timer 1 1 : f(X CIN) 0 : Frequency divider for Timer 2 1 : Not available Timer 2 output selection bit (P7 2) 0 : I/O port 1 : Timer 2 output T2OUT output edge switch bit 0 : Start at “L” output 1 : Start at “H” output b7 b7 b0 Timer 1 frequency division selection bits b1b0 Timer 4 count stop bit 0 : Count operation 1 : Count stop (1) 0 0 : 1/16 × φ SOURCE 0 1 : 1/1 × φ SOURCE 1 0 : 1/2 × φ SOURCE 1 1 : 1/256 × φ SOURCE Timer 2 frequency division selection bits Timer 3 count source selection bit 0 : Frequency divider for Timer 3 1 : Underflow of Timer 2 b3b2 0 0 1 1 Timer 4 count source selection bits b4b3 0 0 : Frequency divider for Timer 4 0 1 : Underflow of Timer 3 1 0 : Underflow of Timer 2 1 1 : f(XIN) Timer 3 operating mode selection bit 0 : Timer mode 1 : PWM mode 0 : 1/16 × φ SOURCE 1 : 1/1 × φ SOURCE 0 : 1/2 × φ SOURCE 1 : 1/256 × φ SOURCE Timer 3 frequency division selection bits b5b4 0 0 1 1 Timer 4 operating mode selection bit 0 : Timer mode 1 : PWM mode 0 : 1/16 × φSOURCE 1 : 1/1 × φ SOURCE 0 : 1/2 × φ SOURCE 1 : 1/256 × φ SOURCE Timer 4 frequency division selection bits b7b6 0 0 1 1 Not used (returns “0” when read) b7 b0 Timer 1234 frequency division selection register (PRE1234: address 002816) Timer 34 mode register (T34M: address 002616) Timer 3 count stop bit 0 : Count operation 1 : Count stop 0 : 1/16 × φ SOURCE 1 : 1/1 × φ SOURCE 0 : 1/2 × φ SOURCE 1 : 1/256 × φ SOURCE b0 Timer 1234 mode register (T1234M: address 002716) T3OUT output edge switch bit 0 : Start at “L” output 1 : Start at “H” output T4OUT output edge switch bit 0 : Start at “L” output 1 : Start at “H” output Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode Timer 3 output selection bit (P7 3) 0 : I/O port 1 : Timer 3 output Timer 4 output selection bit (P7 4) 0 : I/O port 1 : Timer 4 output Timer 2 write control bit 0 : Write data to both timer latch and timer 1 : Write data to timer latch only Timer 3 write control bit 0 : Write data to both timer latch and timer 1 : Write data to timer latch only Timer 4 write control bit 0 : Write data to both timer latch and timer 1 : Write data to timer latch only Not used (returns “0” when read) Fig. 27 Structure of timer 1 to timer 4 related registers Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 37 of 134 38D5 Group 16-bit Timer Read and write operation on 16-bit timer must be performed for both high and low-order bytes. When reading a 16-bit timer, read the high-order byte first. When writing to a 16-bit timer, write the low-order byte first. The 16-bit timer cannot perform the correct operation when reading during the write operation, or when writing during the read operation. XIN φSOURCE (1) 2 Frequency divider Timer X frequency division selection bits “0” Timer X count source selection bit XcIN “1” Timer 1 interrupt “001” Timer X count “010” stop bit “011” “101” Latch “00” Timer X (low-order) latch (8) Timer X (high-order) latch (8) Extend latch (2) CNTR0 Timer X (low-order)(8) Both edges detection “000” “001” “011” “100” “101” Timer X operating mode bits Timer X write control bit “000” D Q Data for control of event counter window “01” Timer X (high-order)(8) Extend counter (2) CNTR0 interrupt request Pulse width measurement mode Timer X output Timer X operating “010” mode bits control bit 1 Edge selection Timer X output control bit 2 Edge detection Compare register 1 (low-order)(8) Compare register 1 (high-order)(8) Compare register 2 (low-order)(8) Compare register 2 (high-order)(8) Edge selection INT2 Compare register 3 (low-order)(8) Compare register 3 (high-order)(8) R Q T Q Pulse output mode “0” P65/TXOUT1/(LED3) S Q P65 direction register P65 latch Timer X output 1 selection bit “1” T Timer X output 1 Q active edge switch bit IGBT output mode PWM mode “0” R Q P63/TXOUT2/(LED1) P63 direction register P63 latch “1” Timer X output 2 active edge switch bit Q Timer X output 2 selection bit Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode Fig. 28 Timer X block diagram Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Timer X interrupt request “100” “10” “11” CNTR0 active edge switch bits INT10/INT11 INT0 interrupt request 16/f(XIN) “11” Clock for Timer X “0” Data bus External trigger delay time selection bits “00” 0 µs Trigger for IGBT input control bit 4/f(XIN) “01” “1” Timer X operating Delay “010” mode bits Delay circuit 1/2 8/f(XIN) “10” circuit Noise filter (4 times same levels judgment) Edge selection INT00/INT01 Noise filter sampling Trigger for IGBT input control bit clock selection bit “1” 1/4 “1” ×2 Frequency divider 1/2 “0” “0” Page 38 of 134 T Equal 38D5 Group • Frequency Divider For Timer Each timer X and timer Y have the frequency dividers for the count source. The count source of the frequency divider is switched to XIN, XCIN, or the on-chip oscillator OCO divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode by the CPU mode register. The division ratio of each timer can be controlled by each timer division ratio selection bit. The division ratio can be selected from as follows; 1/1, 1/2, 1/16, 1/256 of f(XIN), f(XCIN) or f(OCO)/4. Switch the frequency division or count source* while the timer count is stopped. *This also applies when the frequency divider output is selected as the timer count source and the count source is switched in conjunction with a transition between operating modes (onchip oscillator mode, XIN mode, or low-speed mode). Be careful when changing settings in the CPU mode register. • Timer X The count source for timer X can be set using the timer X mode register. XCIN may be selected as the count source. If XCIN is selected, count operation is possible regardless of whether or not the XIN input oscillator or the on-chip oscillator is operating. The timer X operates as down-count. When the timer contents reach “000016”, an underflow occurs at the next count pulse and the timer latch contents are reloaded. After that, the timer continues countdown. When the timer underflows, the interrupt request bit corresponding to the timer X is set to “1”. Six operating modes can be selected for timer X by the timer X mode register and timer X control register. (1) Timer Mode The count source can be selected by setting the timer X mode register. In this mode, timer X operates as the 18-bit counter by setting the timer X register (extension). (2) Pulse Output Mode Pulses of which polarity is inverted each time the timer underflows are output from the TXOUT1 pin. Except for that, this mode operates just as in the timer mode. When using this mode, set the port sharing the TXOUT1 pin to output mode. (3) IGBT Output Mode After dummy output from the TXOUT1 pin, count starts with the INT0 pin input as a trigger. In the case that the timer X output 1 active edge switch bit is “0”, when the trigger is detected or the timer X underflows, “H” is output from the TXOUT1 pin. And then, when the count value corresponds with the compare register 1 value, the TXOUT1 output becomes “L”. After noise is cleared by noise filters, judging continuous 4-time same levels with sampling clocks to be signals, the INT0 signal can use 4 types of delay time by a delay circuit. When using this mode, set the port sharing the INT0 pin to input mode and set the port sharing the pin used as TXOUT1 or TXOUT2 function to output mode. When the timer X output control bit 1 or 2 of the timer X control register is set to “1”, the timer X count stop bit is fixed to “1” forcibly by the interrupt signal of INT1 or INT2. And then, the TXOUT1 output and TXOUT2 output can be set to “L” forcibly at the same time that the timer X stops counting. Do not write “1” to the timer X register (extension) when using the IGBT output mode. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 39 of 134 (4) PWM Mode IGBT dummy output, an external trigger with the INT0 pin and output control with pins INT1 and INT2 are not used. Except for those, this mode operates just as in the IGBT output mode. The period of PWM waveform is specified by the timer X set value. In the case that the timer X output 1 active edge switch bit is “0”, the “H” interval is specified by the compare register 1 set value. In the case that the timer X output 2 active edge switch bit is “0”, the “H” interval is specified by the compare registers 2 and 3 set values. When using this mode, set the port sharing the pin used as TXOUT1 or TXOUT2 function to output mode. Do not write “1” to the timer X register (extension) when using the PWM mode. (5) Event Counter Mode The timer counts signals input through the CNTR0 pin. In this mode, timer X operates as the 18-bit counter by setting the timer X register (extension). When using this mode, set the port sharing the CNTR0 pin to input mode. In this mode, the window control can be performed by the timer 1 underflow. When the bit 5 (data for control of event counter window) of the timer X mode register is set to “1”, counting is stopped at the next timer 1 underflow. When the bit is set to “0”, counting is restarted at the next timer 1 underflow. (6) Pulse Width Measurement Mode In this mode, the count source is the output of frequency divider for timer. In this mode, timer X operates as the 18-bit counter by setting the timer X register (extension). When the bit 6 of the CNTR 0 active edge switch bits is “0”, counting is executed during the “H” interval of CNTR0 pin input. When the bit is “1”, counting is executed during the “L” interval of CNTR0 pin input. When using this mode, set the port sharing the CNTR0 pin to input mode. Also, set to enable (“0”) the data for control of event counter window (bit 5 of timer X mode register (address 002D16)). 38D5 Group ts Timer X count source Timer X PWM mode IGBT output mode External trigger (INT0 source) is generated. INT1 or INT2 source is generated. Level is “H” only IGBT output mode. TXOUT1 output (TXCON1 bit 5 = “0”) m × ts TXOUT2 output (TXCON2 bit 1 = “0”) Level is forcibly “L” only IGBT output mode. q × ts p × ts (n+1) × ts n : Timer X setting value m: Compare register 1 setting value p : Compare register 2 setting value q : Compare register 3 setting value ts: One period of timer X count source The following PWM waveform is output; Duty of TXOUT1 output :{(n+1)-m}/(n+1), Duty of TXOUT2 output :(p-q)/(n+1), Period :(n+1) × ts Fig. 29 Waveform of PWM/IGBT <Notes on Timer X> (1) Write Order to Timer X • In the timer mode, pulse output mode, event counter mode and pulse width measurement mode, write to the following registers in the order as shown below; the timer X register (extension), the timer X register (low-order), the timer X register (high-order). Do not write to only one of them. When the above mode is set and timer X operates as the 16-bit counter, if the timer X register (extension) is never set after reset is released, setting the timer X register (extension) is not required. In this case, write the timer X register (low-order) first and the timer X register (high-order). However, once writing to the timer X register (extension) is executed, note that the value is retained to the reload latch. • Write to the timer X register by the 16-bit unit. Do not read the timer X register while write operation is performed. If the write operation is not completed, normal operation will not be performed. • In the IGBT output and PWM modes, do not write “1” to the timer X register (extension). Also, when “1” is already written to the timer X register, be sure to write “0” to the register before using. Write to the following registers in the order as shown below; the compare registers 1, 2, 3 (high- and low-order), the timer X register (extension), the timer X register (low-order), the timer X register (high-order). It is possible to use whichever order to write to the compare registers 1, 2, 3 (high- and low-order). However, write both the compare registers 1, 2, 3 and the timer X register at the same time. For the compare registers, set a value less than the setting value in the timer X register. Also, do not set “0016”. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 40 of 134 (2) Read Order to Timer X • In all modes, read the following registers in the order as shown below; the timer X register (extension), the timer X register (high-order), the timer X register (low-order). When reading the timer X register (extension) is not required, read the timer X register (high-order) first and the timer X register (low-order). Read order to the compare registers 1, 2, 3 is not specified. • Read from the timer X register by the 16-bit unit. Do not write to the timer X register while read operation is performed. If the read operation is not completed, normal operation will not be performed. (3) Write to Timer X • Which write control can be selected by the timer X write control bit (b3) of the timer X mode register (address 2D16), writing data to both the latch and the timer at the same time or writing data only to the latch. When writing a value to the timer X address to write to the latch only, the value is set into the reload latch and the timer is updated at the next underflow. After reset release, when writing a value to the timer X address, the value is set into the timer and the timer latch at the same time, because they are written at the same time. When writing to the latch only, if the write timing to the highorder reload latch and the underflow timing are almost the same, the value is set into the timer and the timer latch at the same time. In this time, counting is stopped during writing to the high-order reload latch. • Switch the frequency division or count source* while the timer count is stopped. *This also applies when the frequency divider output is selected as the timer count source and the count source is switched in conjunction with a transition between operating modes (onchip oscillator mode, XIN mode, or low-speed mode). Be careful when changing settings in the CPU mode register. 38D5 Group (4) Set of Timer X Mode Register Set the write control bit of the timer X mode register to “1” (write to the latch only) when setting the IGBT output and PWM modes. Output waveform simultaneously reflects the contents of both registers at the next underflow after writing to the timer X register (high-order). (5) Output Control Function of Timer X • When using the output control function (INT1 and INT2) in the IGBT output mode, set the levels of INT1 and INT2 to “H” in the falling edge active or to “L” in the rising edge active before switching to the IGBT output mode. (7) When Timer X Pulse Width Measurement Mode Used When timer X pulse width measurement mode is used, enable the event counter wind control data (bit 5 of timer X mode register (address 002D16)) by setting to “0”. <Reason> If the event counter window control data (bit 5 of timer X mode r egister (add ress 002 D 1 6 )) is set to “1” (disabled) to enable/disable the CNTR0 input, the input is not accepted after the timer 1 underflow. (6) Switch of CNTR0 Active Edge • When the CNTR0 active edge switch bits are set, at the same time, the interrupt active edge is also affected. When the pulse width is measured, set the bit 7 of the CNTR0 active edge switch bits to “0”. b7 b7 b0 Timer X mode register (TXM: address 002D16) Timer X operating mode bits b2b1b0 0 0 0 : Timer mode 0 0 1 : Pulse output mode 0 1 0 : IGBT output mode 0 1 1 : PWM mode 1 0 0 : Event counter mode 1 0 1 : Pulse width measurement mode 1 1 0 : Not available 1 1 1 : Not available Timer X write control bit 0 : Write data to both timer latch and timer 1 : Write data to timer latch only Timer X count source selection bit 0 : Frequency divider output 1 : f(XCIN) Data for control of event counter window 0 : Event count enabled 1 : Event count disabled Timer X count stop bit 0 : Count operation 1 : Count stop Timer X output 1 selection bit (P6 5) 0 : I/O port 1 : Timer X output 1 b7 b0 Timer X control register 2 (TXCON2: address 002F16) Timer X output 2 control bit (P6 3) 0 : I/O port 1 : Timer X output 2 Timer X output 2 active edge switch bit 0 : Start at “L” output 1 : Start at “H” output Timer X dividing frequency selection bits b3b2 0 0 : 1/16 × φ SOURCE 0 1 : 1/1 × φ SOURCE (1) 1 0 : 1/2 × φ SOURCE 1 1 : 1/256 × φ SOURCE Trigger for IGBT input control bit 0 : Noise filter sampling clock × 1 External trigger delay time × 1 1 : Noise filter sampling clock × 2 External trigger delay time × 1/2 Not used (returns “0” when read) Fig. 30 Structure of Timer X related registers Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 41 of 134 b0 Timer X control register 1 (TXCON1: address 002E16) Noise filter sampling clock selection bit 0 : f(XIN)/2 1 : f(XIN)/4 External trigger delay time selection bits b2b1 0 0 : Not delayed 0 1 : (4/f(XIN)) µs 1 0 : (8/f(XIN)) µs 1 1 : (16/f(XIN)) µs Timer X output control bit 1 (P6 6 or P71) 0 : Not used INT1 interrupt signal 1 : INT1 interrupt signal used Timer X output control bit 2 (P6 4) 0 : Not used INT2 interrupt signal 1 : INT2 interrupt signal used Timer X output 1 active edge switch bit 0 : Start at “L” output 1 : Start at “H” output CNTR0 active edge switch bits b7b6 0 0 : Count at rising edge in event counter mode Falling edge active for CNTR 0 interrupt Measure “H” pulse width in pulse width measurement mode 0 1 : Count at falling edge in event counter mode Rising edge active for CNTR 0 interrupt Measure “L” pulse width in pulse width measurement mode 1 0 : Count at both edges in event counter mode 1 1 : Both edges active for CNTR 0 interrupt Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode 38D5 Group Data bus (1) φSOURCE 2 Frequency divider Timer Y operating mode bits Timer Y dividing frequency selection bit “00”, “01”, “10” “0” “1” Rising edge detection XcIN Count source selection bit Falling edge detection CNTR1 active edge switch bit “0” “11” Period measurement mode Timer Y (low-order) latch (8) Timer Y (high-order) latch (8) “00”, “01”, “11” Timer Y (low-order)(8) Timer Y (high-order)(8) “10” Timer Y operating mode bits “1” Real time port 2 control bit “1” RTP1 data for real time port Q D P51/RTP1/AN1 Timer Y interrupt request Real time port 2 control bit “0” Timer Y mode register write signal Latch “0” “1” P51 latch Real time port 1 control bit “1” RTP0 data for real time port Q D P50/RTP0/AN0 P50 direction register CNTR1 interrupt request Timer Y write control bit Timer Y count stop bit CNTR1 P51 direction register Pulse width HL continuous measurement mode “0” Real time port 1 control bit “0” Timer Y mode register write signal Latch “1” P50 latch Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode Fig. 31 Block diagram of Timer Y • Timer Y Timer Y is a 16-bit timer. The timer Y count source can be selected by setting the timer Y mode register. X CIN can be selected as the count source. When XCIN is selected as the count source, counting can be performed regardless of XIN oscillation or on-chip oscillator oscillation. Four operating modes can be selected for timer Y by the timer Y mode register. Also, the real time port can be controlled. (1) Timer Mode The timer Y count source can be selected by setting the timer Y mode register. (2) Period Measurement Mode The interrupt request is generated at rising or falling edge of CNTR1 pin input signal. Simultaneously, the value in timer Y latch is reloaded in timer Y and timer Y continues counting. Except for that, this mode operates just as in the timer mode. The timer value just before the reloading at rising or falling of CNTR1 pin input is retained until the timer Y is read once after the reload. The rising or falling timing of CNTR1 pin input is found by CNTR1 interrupt. When using this mode, set the port sharing the CNTR1 pin to input mode. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 42 of 134 (3) Event Counter Mode The timer counts signals input through the CNTR1 pin. Except for that, this mode operates just as in the timer mode. When using this mode, set the port sharing the CNTR1 pin to input mode. (4) Pulse Width HL Continuously Measurement Mode The interrupt request is generated at both rising and falling edges of CNTR1 pin input signal. Except for that, this mode operates just as in the period measurement mode. When using this mode, set the port sharing the CNTR1 pin to input mode. (5) Real Time Port Control When the real time port function is valid, data for the real time port is output from ports P5 0 and P5 1 each time the timer Y underflows.(However, if the real time port control bit is changed from “0” to “1” after the data for real time port is set, data is output independent of the timer Y operation.) When the data for the real time port is changed while the real time port function is valid, the changed data is output at the next underflow of timer Y. Before using this function, set the P50 and P51 port direction registers to output. 38D5 Group <Notes on Timer Y> • CNTR1 Interrupt Active Edge Selection CNTR1 interrupt active edge depends on the CNTR1 active edge switch bit. However, in pulse width HL continuously measurement mode, CNTR1 interrupt request is generated at both rising and falling edges of CNTR 1 pin input signal regardless of the setting of CNTR1 active edge switch bit. • Switch the frequency division or count source* while the timer count is stopped. *This also applies when the frequency divider output is selected as the timer count source and the count source is switched in conjunction with a transition between operating modes (on-chip oscillator mode, XIN mode, or low-speed mode). Be careful when changing settings in the CPU mode register. • Timer Y Read/Write Control • When reading from/writing to timer Y, read from/write to both the high-order and low-order bytes of timer Y. When the value is read, read the high-order bytes first and the low-order bytes next. When the value is written, write the low-order bytes first and the high-order bytes next. Write to or read from the timer Y register by the 16-bit unit. If reading from the timer Y register during write operation or writing to it during read operation is performed, normal operation will not be performed. • Which write control can be selected by the timer Y write control bit (b0) of the timer Y control register (address 0039 16), writing data to both the latch and the timer at the same time or writing data only to the latch. When writing a value to the timer Y address to write to the latch only, the value is set into the reload latch and the timer is updated at the next underflow. After reset release, when writing a value to the timer Y address, the value is set into the timer and the timer latch at the same time, because they are set to write at the same time. When writing to the latch only, if the write timing to the highorder reload latch and the underflow timing are almost the same, the value is set into the timer and the timer latch at the same time. In this time, counting is stopped during writing to the high-order reload latch. b7 b7 b0 Timer Y mode register (TYM: address 003816) Real time port 1 control bit (P5 0) 0 : Real time port function invalid 1 : Real time port function valid Real time port 2 control bit (P5 1) 0 : Real time port function invalid 1 : Real time port function valid RTP0 data for real time port RTP1 data for real time port Timer Y operating mode bits b5 b4 0 0 : Timer mode 0 1 : Period measurement mode 1 0 : Event counter mode 1 1 : Pulse width HL continuous measurement mode CNTR1 active edge switch bit 0 : Count at rising edge in event counter mode Measure falling period in period measurement mode Falling edge active for CNTR 1 interrupt 1 : Count at falling edge in event counter mode Measure rising period in period measurement mode Rising edge active for CNTR 1 interrupt Timer Y count stop bit 0 : Count operation 1 : Count stop Fig. 32 Structure of Timer Y related registers Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 43 of 134 b0 Timer Y control register (TYCON: address 003916) Timer Y write control bit 0 : Write data to both timer latch and timer 1 : Write data to timer latch only Timer Y count source selection bit 0 : Frequency divider output 1 : f(XCIN) Timer Y frequency division selection bits b3 b2 0 0 1 1 (1) 0 : 1/16 × φSOURCE 1 : 1/1 × φSOURCE 0 : 1/2 × φSOURCE 1 : 1/256 × φSOURCE Not used (returns “0” when read) Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •Internal on-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode 38D5 Group SERIAL INTERFACE • SERIAL I/O1 Serial I/O1 can be used as either clock synchronous or asynchronous (UART) serial I/O. A dedicated timer is also provided for baud rate generation. (1) Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode Clock synchronous serial I/O1 mode can be selected by setting the serial I/O mode selection bit of the serial I/O1 control register to “1”. For clock synchronous serial I/O1, the transmitter and the receiver must use the same clock. If an internal clock is used, transfer is started by a write signal to the TB/RB. Data bus Address 001816 Serial I/O1 control register Receive buffer register P40/RXD Address 001A16 Receive buffer full flag (RBF) Receive interrupt request (RI) Receive shift register Shift clock Clock control circuit P42/SCLK1 φSOURCE (1) Serial I/O1 synchronous clock selection bit Frequency division ratio 1/(n+1) Baud rate generator 1/4 Address 001C16 BRG count source selection bit 1/4 P43/SRDY1 F/F Falling-edge detector Clock control circuit Transmit shift completion flag (TSC) Shift clock P41/TXD Transmit interrupt source selection bit Transmit interrupt request (TI) Transmit shift register Transmit buffer register Address 001816 Transmit buffer empty flag (TBE) Address 001916 Serial I/O1 status register Data bus Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode Fig. 33 Block diagram of clock synchronous serial I/O1 Transfer shift clock (1/2 to 1/2048 of the internal clock, or an external clock) Serial output TxD D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Serial input RxD D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Receive enable signal SRDY Write pulse to receive/transmit buffer register TBE = 0 TBE = 1 TSC = 0 RBF = 1 TSC = 1 Overrun error (OE) detection Notes 1: As the transmit interrupt (TI) source, which can be selected, either when the transmit buffer has emptied (TBE = 1) or after the transmit shift operation has ended (TSC = 1), by setting the transmit interrupt source selection bit (TIC) of the serial I/O1 control register. 2: If data is written to the transmit buffer register when TSC=0, the transmit clock is generated continuously and serial data is output continuously from the TxD pin. 3: The receive interrupt (RI) is set when the receive buffer full flag (RBF) becomes “1” . Fig. 34 Operation of clock synchronous serial I/O1 function Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 44 of 134 38D5 Group (2) Asynchronous Serial I/O (UART) Mode Clock asynchronous serial I/O mode (UART) can be selected by setting the serial I/O mode selection bit of the serial I/O1 control register to “0”. Eight serial data transfer formats can be selected, and the transfer formats used by a transmitter and receiver must be identical. The transmit and receive shift registers each have a buffer, but the two buffers have the same address in memory. Since the shift register cannot be written to or read from directly, transmit data is written to the transmit buffer register, and receive data is read from the receive buffer register. The transmit buffer register can also hold the next data to be transmitted, and the receive buffer register can hold a character while the next character is being received. Data bus Address 001816 P40/RXD Serial I/O1 control register Address 001A16 OE Receive buffer register Character length selection bit ST detector 7 bits Receive shift register Receive buffer full flag (RBF) Receive interrupt request (RI) 1/16 8 bits PE FE UART control register SP detector Address 001B16 Clock control circuit Serial I/O1 synchronous clock selection bit P42/SCLK1 φSOURCE (1) BRG count source selection bit Frequency division ratio 1/(n+1) Baud rate generator Address 001C16 1/4 ST/SP/PA generator Transmit shift completion flag (TSC) 1/16 P41/TXD Transmit interrupt source selection bit Transmit interrupt request (TI) Transmit shift register Character length selection bit Transmit buffer empty flag (TBE) Address 001916 Transmit buffer register Address 001816 Serial I/O1 status register Data bus Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode Fig. 35 Block diagram of UART serial I/O1 Transmit or receive clock Transmit buffer register write signal TBE=0 TSC=0 TBE=1 TBE=0 TSC=1∗ TBE=1 Serial output TxD ST D0 D1 SP ST D0 SP D1 ∗ Generated at 2nd bit in 2-stop-bit mode 1 start bit 7 or 8 data bit 1 or 0 parity bit 1 or 2 stop bit (s) Receive buffer register read signal RBF=0 RBF=1 RBF=1 Serial input RxD ST D0 D1 SP ST D0 D1 Notes 1: Error flag detection occurs at the same time that the RBF flag becomes “1” (at 1st stop bit, during reception). 2: As the transmit interrupt (TI), when either the TBE or TSC flag becomes “1”, can be selected to occur depending on the setting of the transmit interrupt source selection bit (TIC) of the serial I/O control register. 3: The receive interrupt (RI) is set when the RBF flag becomes “1”. 4: After data is written to the transmit buffer when TSC flag = “1”, 0.5 to 1.5 cycles of the data shift cycle is necessary until changing to TSC flag = “0”. Fig. 36 Operation of UART serial I/O1 function Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 45 of 134 SP 38D5 Group [Transmit Buffer Register/Receive Buffer Register (TB1/RB1)] The transmit buffer register and the receive buffer register are located at the same address. The transmit buffer is write-only and the receive buffer is read-only. If a character bit length is 7 bits, the MSB of data stored in the receive buffer is “0”. [Serial I/O1 Status Register (SIO1STS)] The read-only serial I/O1 status register consists of seven flags (bits 0 to 6) which indicate the operating status of the serial I/O function and various errors. Three of the flags (bits 4 to 6) are valid only in UART mode. The receive buffer full flag (bit 1) is set to “0” when the receive buffer register is read. If there is an error, it is detected at the same time that data is transferred from the receive shift register to the receive buffer register, and the receive buffer full flag is set. A write to the serial I/O1 status register sets all the error flags OE, PE, FE, and SE (bit 3 to bit 6, respectively) to “0”. Writing “0” to the serial I/O1 enable bit SIOE (bit 7 of the serial I/O1 control register) also sets all the status flags to “0”, including the error flags. All bits of the serial I/O1 status register are set to “0” at reset, but if the transmit enable bit (bit 4) of the serial I/O1 control register has been set to “1”, the transmit shift completion flag (bit 2) and the transmit buffer empty flag (bit 0) become “1”. [Serial I/O1 Control Register (SIO1CON)] The serial I/O1 control register consists of eight control bits for the serial I/O1 function. [UART Control Register (UARTCON)] The UART control register consists of four control bits (bits 0 to 3) which are valid when asynchronous serial I/O is selected and set the data format of the data transfer and one bit (bit 4) which is always valid and sets the output structure of the P41/TXD pin. [Baud Rate Generator (BRG)] The baud rate generator determines the baud rate for serial transfer. The baud rate generator divides the frequency of the count source by 1/(n + 1), where n is the value written to the baud rate generator. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 46 of 134 <Notes on serial I/O1> When setting transmit enable bit of serial I/O1 to “1”, the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt request bit is automatically set to “1”. When not requiring the interrupt occurrence synchronous with the transmission enabled, take the following sequence. (1) Set the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt enable bit to “0” (disabled). (2) Set the transmit enable bit to “1”. (3) Set the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt request bit to “0” after 1 or more instructions have been executed. (4) Set the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt enable bit to “1” (enabled). 38D5 Group b7 b7 b0 b0 Serial I/O1 status register (SIO1STS : address 001916) b7 b0 Serial I/O1 control register (SIO1CON : address 001A16) Transmit buffer empty flag (TBE) 0: Buffer full 1: Buffer empty BRG count source selection bit (CSS) 0: φSOURCE (1) 1: φSOURCE/4 Receive buffer full flag (RBF) 0: Buffer empty 1: Buffer full Transmit shift completion flag (TSC) 0: Transmit shift in progress 1: Transmit shift completed Serial I/O1 synchronous clock selection bit (SCS) 0: BRG output divided by 4 when clock synchronous serial I/O is selected. BRG output divided by 16 when UART is selected. 1: External clock input when clock synchronous serial I/O is selected. External clock input divided by 16 when UART is selected. Overrun error flag (OE) 0: No error 1: Overrun error SRDY1 output enable bit (SRDY) 0: P43 pin operates as ordinary I/O pin 1: P43 pin operates as SRDY1 output pin Parity error flag (PE) 0: No error 1: Parity error Transmit interrupt source selection bit (TIC) 0: Interrupt when transmit buffer has emptied 1: Interrupt when transmit shift operation is completed Framing error flag (FE) 0: No error 1: Framing error Transmit enable bit (TE) 0: Transmit disabled 1: Transmit enabled Summing error flag (SE) 0: (OE) U (PE) U (FE)=0 1: (OE) U (PE) U (FE)=1 Receive enable bit (RE) 0: Receive disabled 1: Receive enabled Not used (returns “1” when read) Serial I/O1 mode selection bit (SIOM) 0: Clock asynchronous (UART) serial I/O 1: Clock synchronous serial I/O Serial I/O1 enable bit (SIOE) 0: Serial I/O1 disabled (pins P40 to P43 operate as ordinary I/O pins) 1: Serial I/O1 enabled (pins P40 to P43 operate as serial I/O pins) UART control register (UARTCON : address 001B16) Character length selection bit (CHAS) 0: 8 bits 1: 7 bits Parity enable bit (PARE) 0: Parity checking disabled 1: Parity checking enabled Parity selection bit (PARS) 0: Even parity 1: Odd parity Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode Stop bit length selection bit (STPS) 0: 1 stop bit 1: 2 stop bits P41/TXD P-channel output disable bit (POFF) 0: CMOS output (in output mode) 1: N-channel open drain output (in output mode) Not used (return “1” when read) Fig. 37 Structure of serial I/O1 related registers Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 47 of 134 38D5 Group • Serial I/O2 The serial I/O2 function can be used only for clock synchronous serial I/O. For serial I/O2, the transmitter and the receiver must use the same clock. When the internal clock is selected as the operating clock, a write signal to the serial I/O2 register initializes serial I/O2 and transmission/reception starts. When the external clock is selected as the operating clock, a write signal to the serial I/O2 register initializes the serial I/O2 counter and transmission/reception is enabled. Inputting the external clock starts transmission/reception. To write to the serial I/O2 register when the external clock is selected as the operating clock, perform writing while SCLK2 is set to “H”. b7 b0 Serial I/O2 control register (SIO2CON: address 001D16) Internal synchronous clock selection bits b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 : φSOURCE/8 (1) 1 : φSOURCE/16 0 : φSOURCE/32 1 : φSOURCE/64 0 : Not available 1 : Not available 0 : φSOURCE/128 1 : φSOURCE/256 Serial I/O2 port selection bit 0 : I/O port 1 : SOUT2, SCLK2 signal pin [Serial I/O2 control register] SIO2CON The serial I/O2 control register contains 8bits which control various serial I/O functions. P45/SOUT2 P-channel output disable bit 0 : CMOS output (at output mode) 1 : N-channel open-drain output (at output mode) Transfer direction selection bit 0 : LSB first 1 : MSB first Serial I/O2 synchronous clock selection bit 0 : External clock 1 : Internal clock SRDY2 output selection bit 0 : I/O port P47 1 : SRDY2 signal output Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode Fig. 38 Structure of serial I/O2 control registers Internal synchronous clock Data bus selection bits Frequency divider φSOURCE P47 latch (1) Serial I/O2 synchronous clock selection bit “1” Synchronous circuit “0” S CLK2 P47/SRDY2 1/8 1/16 1/32 1/64 1/128 1/256 External clock P46 latch “0” P46/SCLK2 (1) “1” P45 latch “0” Serial I/O2 counter (3) P45/SOUT2 “1” Serial I/O2 port selection bit Serial I/O2 register (8) P44/SIN2 Address 001F16 Notes: 1: It is selected by the serial I/O2 synchronous clock selection bit, S RDY2 output selection bit and serial I/O2 port selection bit. 2: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode Fig. 39 Block diagram of serial I/O2 Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 48 of 134 Serial I/O2 interrupt request 38D5 Group [Serial I/O2 Operation] Writing to the serial I/O2 register initializes the serial I/O2 counter to “7”. After writing, the S OUT2 pin outputs data each time the synchronous clock changes from “H” to “L”. The S IN2 pin captures data each time the synchronous clock changes from “L” to “H” and the serial I/O2 register shifts 1-bit simultaneously. When the external clock is selected as the synchronous clock, counting the synchronous clock eight times results the following: • Serial I/O2 counter = “0” • Synchronous clock is stopped at “H” • Serial I/O2 interrupt request bit = “1” After transfer is completed, the SOUT2 pin is placed in the highimpedance state. Transfer clock When the external clock is selected as the synchronous clock, counting the synchronous clock eight times sets the serial I/O2 bit to “1” and the S OUT2 pin retains the D7 output level. However, if the synchronous clock is continuously input, the serial I/O2 register continues shifting and the SOUT2 pin keeps outputting transmit data. (1) Serial I/O2 register write signal (2) (3) Serial I/O2 output SOUT2 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Serial I/O2 input SIN2 Reception enable signal SRDY2 (When the internal clock is selected) Serial I/O2 interrupt request bit set Notes 1: When the internal clock is selected as the transfer, the dividing frequency of internal clock for transfer clock can be selected by bits 0 to 2 of serial I/O2 control register. 2: When the internal clock is selected as the synchronous clock, the SOUT2 pin is placed in the high impedance state after transfer is completed. 3: When the external clock is selected as the synchronous clock, the SOUT2 pin retains the D7 output level after transfer is completed. However, if the synchronous clock is continuously input, the serial I/O2 register continues shifting and the SOUT2 pin keeps outputting transmit data. Fig. 40 Serial I/O2 timing Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 49 of 134 38D5 Group A/D CONVERTER The 38D5 Group has a 10-bit A/D converter. The A/D converter performs successive approximation conversion. The 38D5 Group has the ADKEY function which perform A/D conversion of the “L” level analog input from the ADKEY pin automatically. [AD Conversion Register (ADL, ADH)] One of these registers is a high-order register, and the other is a low-order register. The high-order 8 bits of a conversion result is stored in the AD conversion register (high-order) (address 001716), and the low-order 2 bits of the same result are stored in bit 7 and bit 6 of the AD conversion register (low-order) (address 001616). During A/D conversion, do not read these registers. Also, the connection between the resistor ladder and reference voltage input pin (VREF) can be controlled by the VREF input switch bit (bit 0 of address 001616). When “1” is written to this bit, the resistor ladder is always connected to VREF. When “0” is written to this bit, the resistor ladder is disconnected from VREF except during the A/D conversion. [AD Control Register (ADCON)] This register controls A/D converter. Bits 2 to 0 are analog input pin selection bits. Bit 3 is an AD conversion completion bit and “0” during A/D conversion. This bit is set to “1” upon completion of A/D conversion. A/D conversion is started by setting “0” in this bit. Bit 5 is the ADKEY enable bit. The ADKEY function is enabled by setting “1” to this bit. When this function is valid, the analog input pin selection bits are ignored. Also, when bit 5 is “1”, do not set “0” to bit 3 by program. [Channel Selector] The channel selector selects one of the input ports P57/AN7− P50/AN0 and inputs it to the comparator. [Comparator and Control Circuit] The comparator and control circuit compare an analog input voltage with the comparison voltage and store the result in the AD conversion register. When an A/D conversion is completed, the control circuit sets the AD conversion completion bit and the AD conversion interrupt request bit to “1”. The comparator is constructed linked to a capacitor. The conversion accuracy may be low because the change is lost if the conversion speed is not enough. Accordingly, set f(X IN ) to at least 500 kHz during A/D conversion in the XIN mode. Also, do not execute the STP and WIT instructions during the A/D conversion. In the low-speed mode and on-chip oscillator mode, there is no limit on the oscillation frequency because the on-chip oscillator is used as the A/D conversion clock. In the low-speed mode, onchip oscillator starts oscillation automatically at the A/D conversion is executed and stops oscillation automatically at the A/D conversion is finished even though it is not oscillating. [Comparison Voltage Generator] The comparison voltage generator divides the voltage between AVSS and VREF, and outputs the divided voltages. Data bus b7 b0 AD control register ADKEY control circuit (1) φSOURCE 1/ 2 1/ 8 A/D control circuit Channel selector P50/AN0 P51/AN1 P52/AN2 P53/AN3 P54/AN4 P55/AN5 P56/AN6 P57/AN7/ADKEY0 Comparator A/D interrupt request AD conversion register (H) AD conversion register (L) (Address 001616) (Address 001716) Resistor ladder AVSS VREF Note 1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the low-speed and the on-chip oscillator mode Fig. 41 Block diagram of A/D converter Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 50 of 134 38D5 Group b7 b0 AD control register (ADCON: address 001516) Analog input pin selection bits b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 : P50/AN0 1 : P51/AN1 0 : P52/AN2 1 : P53/AN3 0 : P54/AN4 1 : P55/AN5 0 : P56/AN6 1 : P57/AN7 AD conversion completion bit 0 : Conversion in progress 1 : Conversion completed AD conversion clock selection bit 0 : φSOURCE/2 (1) 1 : φSOURCE/8 ADKEY enable bit (2) 0 : Disabled 1 : Enabled 10-bit or 8-bit conversion switch bit 0 : 10-bit AD 1 : 8-bit AD ADKEY selection bit 0 : Invalid 1 : Valid At 10bitAD (Read address 001716 before 001616) AD conversion register high-order (Address 001716) b7 AD conversion register low-order (Address 001616) b7 b0 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 (high-order) b0 b1 b0 * (low-order) * VREF input switch bit 0: ON only during A/D conversion 1: ON Note : The bit 5 to bit 1 of address 001616 become “0” at reading. Also, bit 0 is undefined at reading. At 8bitAD (Read only address 001716) b7 (Address 001716) b0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Notes 1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the low-speed and the on-chip oscillator mode 2: When the ADKEY enable bit is “1”, the analog input pin selection bits are invalid. Do not execute the A/D conversion by program while the ADKEY is enabled. Bit 0 to bit 2 of ADCON are not changed even when ADKEY is enabled. Fig. 42 Structure of AD control register Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 51 of 134 ADKEY function The ADKEY function is used to judge the analog input voltage input from the ADKEY pin. When the A/D converter starts operating after VIL (0.7 × Vcc-0.5) or less is input, the event of analog voltage input can be judged with the A/D conversion interrupt. This function can be used with the STP and WIT state. As for the ADKEY function in 38D5 Group, the A/D conversion of analog input voltage immediately after starting ADKEY function is not performed. Therefore, the A/D conversion result immediately after an ADKEY function is undefined. Accordingly, when the A/D conversion result of the analog input voltage input from the ADKEY pin is required, start the A/D conversion by program after the analog input pin corresponding to ADKEY is selected. • ADKEY Selection When the ADKEY pin is used, set the ADKEY selection bit to “1”. The ADKEY selection bit is “0”, just after the A/D conversion is started. • ADKEY Enable The ADKEY function is enabled by writing “1” to the ADKEY enable bit. Surely, in order to enable ADKEY function, set “1” to the ADKEY enable bit, after setting the ADKEY selection bit to “1”. When the ADKEY enable bit of the AD control register is “1”, the analog input pin selection bits become invalid. Please do not write “0” in the AD conversion completion bit by the program during ADKEY enabled state. [ADKEY Control Circuit] In order to obtain a more exact conversion result, by the A/D conversion with ADKEY, execute the following; • set the input to the ADKEY pin into a steep falling waveform, • stabilize the input voltage within 8 clock cycles (1 µs at f(XIN) = 8 MHz) after the input voltage is under VIL The threshold voltage with an actual ADKEY pin is the voltage between VIH-VIL. In order not to make ADKEY operation perform superfluously in a noise etc., in the state of the waiting for an input, set the voltage of an ADKEY pin to VIH (0.9VCC) or more. When the following operations are performed, the A/D conversion operation cannot be guaranteed. • When the CPU mode register is operated during A/D conversion operation, • When the AD conversion control register is operated during A/D conversion operation, • When the STP or WIT instruction is executed during A/D conversion operation. 38D5 Group LCD DRIVE CONTROL CIRCUIT The 38D5 Group has the built-in Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) drive control circuit consisting of the following. • LCD display RAM • Segment output disable register • LCD mode register • Selector • Timing controller • Common driver • Segment driver • Bias control circuit A maximum of 36 segment output pins and 8 common output pins can be used. Up to 256 pixels can be controlled for an LCD display. When the LCD enable bit is set to “1” after data is set in the LCD mode register, the segment output disable register, and the LCD display RAM, the LCD drive control circuit starts reading the display data automatically, performs the bias control and the duty ratio control, and displays the data on the LCD panel. b7 b0 . Table 12 Maximum number of display pixels at each duty ratio Duty ratio 1 2 3 4 8 b7 Maximum number of display pixels 36 dots or 8 segment LCD 4 digits 72 dots or 8 segment LCD 9 digits 108 dots or 8 segment LCD 13 digits 144 dots or 8 segment LCD 18 digits 256 dots or 8 segment LCD 32 digits b0 LCD mode register 1 (LM 1 : address 001316) LCD mode register 2 (LM2 : address 001416) (4) Duty ratio selection bits Voltage multiplier circuit control bit 0 : Voltage multiplier circuit disabled (Input ports P70/INT01, P71/INT11) 1 : Voltage multiplier circuit enabled (C1, C2 pins) VL3 connection bit 0 : Connect LCD internal VL3 to VCC 1 : Connect LCD internal VL3 to VL3 pin Not used (returns “0” when read) b2b1b0 0 0 0 : 1 (Static) 0 0 1 : 2 (use COM0, COM1) 0 1 0 : 3 (use COM0-COM2) 0 1 1 : 4 (use COM0-COM3) 1 0 0 to 1 1 0 : Not available 1 1 1 : 8 (COM0-COM7) Bias control bit 0 : 1/3 bias (1) 1 : 1/2 bias LCD enable bit 0 : LCD OFF 1 : LCD ON LCD circuit divider division ratio selection bits b6b5 0 0 : Clock input 0 1 : 2 division of clock input 1 0 : 4 division of clock input 1 1 : 8 division of clock input LCDCK count source selection bit (2) 0 : f(XCIN)/32 1 : φSOURCE/8192 b7 b7 b0 b7 b0 Segment output disable register 0 (SEG0 : address 0FF416) (3) Segment output disable register 1 (SEG1 : address 0FF516) (3) Segment output disable bit 0 0 : Segment output SEG8 1 : Output port P00 Segment output disable bit 1 0 : Segment output SEG9 1 : Output port P01 Segment output disable bit 2 0 : Segment output SEG10 1 : Output port P02 Segment output disable bit 3 0 : Segment output SEG11 1 : Output port P03 Segment output disable bit 4 0 : Segment output SEG12 1 : Output port P04 Segment output disable bit 5 0 : Segment output SEG13 1 : Output port P05 Segment output disable bit 6 0 : Segment output SEG14 1 : Output port P06 Segment output disable bit 7 0 : Segment output SEG15 1 : Output port P07 Segment output disable bit 8 0 : Segment output SEG0 1 : Output port P20 Segment output disable bit 9 0 : Segment output SEG1 1 : Output port P21 Segment output disable bit 10 0 : Segment output SEG2 1 : Output port P22 Segment output disable bit 11 0 : Segment output SEG3 1 : Output port P23 Segment output disable bit 12 0 : Segment output SEG4 1 : Output port P24 Segment output disable bit 13 0 : Segment output SEG5 1 : Output port P25 Segment output disable bit 14 0 : Segment output SEG6 1 : Output port P26 Segment output disable bit 15 0 : Segment output SEG7 1 : Output port P27 b0 Segment output disable register 2 (SEG2 : address 0FF616) (3) Segment output disable bit 16 0 : Segment output SEG16-SEG19 1 : Output port P10-P13 Segment output disable bit 17 0 : Segment output SEG20-SEG23 1 : Output port P14-P17 Segment output disable bit 18 0 : Segment output SEG24-SEG27 1 : Output port P30-P33 Segment output disable bit 19 0 : Segment output SEG28-SEG31 1 : Output port P34-P37 Not used (do not write “1”) Fig. 43 Structure of LCD related registers Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 52 of 134 Notes 1: When “1” is selected as duty ratio by the duty ratio selection bits, set “1” to the bias control bit. 2: LCDCK is a clock for the LCD timing controller. φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode 3: Only pins set to output ports by the direction register can be controlled to switch to output ports or segment outputs by the segment output disable register. 4: When disabling the voltage multiplier circuit, the C1 and C2 pins function as input ports P70/INT01, P71/INT11. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Address 0841 16 Address 0842 16 Address 0843 16 Fig. 44 Block diagram of LCD controller/driver Page 53 of 134 Level shift Level shift Level shift COM 7 / SEG 32 Level shift COM 5 / SEG 34 COM 4 / SEG 35 Segment Segment driver driver Level shift (2) V L3 connection bit V SS V L1 V L2 V L3 C 1 C 2 Level shift Level shift Level shift Level shift “1” “0” Level shift LCDCK Level shift LCD divider Timing controller 2 Level shift φSOURCE/8192 f(X CIN )/32 LCDCK count source selection bit COM 0 COM 1 COM 2 COM 3 COM 4/ COM 5 / COM 6 / COM 7 / SEG 35 SEG 34 SEG 33 SEG 32 Common Common Common Common Common Common Common Common driver driver driver driver driver driver driver driver V CC Level shift 2 Duty ratio selection bits LCD circuit divider division ratio selection bits LCD enable bit Voltage multiplier control bit Bias control bit Bias control Address LCD display RAM 0863 16 Selector Selector Address 0862 16 Notes 1: LCDCK is the clock for the LCD timing controller. φSOURCE indicates the followings: •X IN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode 2: When the voltage multiplier circuit is not used (bit 0 of LCD mode register 2 = “0”), the C 1 and C 2 pins function as input ports P7 0 /INT 01 , P7 1/INT 11. P20 /SEG 0 P2 1 /SEG 1 P22 /SEG 2 P2 3 /SEG 3 Segment Segment Segment Segment driver driver driver driver Level shift Selector Selector Selector Selector Address 0840 16 Data bus (1) 38D5 Group 38D5 Group • Voltage Multiplier The voltage multiplier performs threefold boosting. This circuit inputs a reference voltage for boosting from LCD power input pin VL1. Set each bit of the segment output disable registers and the LCD mode registers in the following order for operating the voltage multiplier. (1) Set the segment output disable bits (bits 0 to 19) of the segment output disable registers (SEG0, 1, 2) to “0” or “1”. (2) Set the duty ratio selection bits (bits 0 to 2), the bias control bit (bit 3), the LCD circuit divider division ratio selection bits (bits 5 and 6), and the LCDCK count source selection bit (bit 7) of the LCD mode register 1 to “0” or “1”. (3) Set the VL3 connection bit (bit 1 of the LCD mode register 2 (LM2)) to “1”. (4) Set the voltage multiplier control bit (bit0) of the LCD mode register 2 to “1”. When voltage is input to the VL1 pin during operating the voltage multiplier, voltage that is twice as large as VL1 occurs at the VL2 pin, and voltage that is three times as large as VL1 occurs at the VL3 pin. The voltage multiplier is controlled by the voltage multiplier control bit (bit 0 of the LCD mode register 2). In addition, when the voltage multiplier is used, set the voltage multiplier control bit to “1” (voltage multiplier enabled) after the voltage 1.3 V or more and 2.1 V or less. When the voltage multiplier is not used, set the VL3 connection bit to “1” (open), and apply the suitable voltage for the power supply input pins for LCD (VL1-VL3). When VL3 connection bit is set to be open, VL3 pin is in a high impedance state. When the voltage multiplier is used, set the LCDCK frequency to 100 Hz or more. The on-chip oscillator cannot be used for LCDCK. In a system where the multiplier circuit is used (a multiplier capacitor is externally connected between the C1 and C2 pins), set the voltage multiplier circuit control bit to “1” (voltage multiplier circuit enabled) before executing the STP or WIT instruction. • Bias Control and Applied Voltage to LCD Power Input Pins Apply the voltage value shown in Table 13 according to the bias value to the LCD power input pins. Apply the voltage value shown in Table 13 according to the bias value by setting to VL3 connection bit (bit 1 of LCD mode register 1) to “1”, when the voltage multiplier is not used. Select a bias value by the bias control bit (bit 3 of the LCD mode register 1). Table 13 Bias control and applied voltage to VL1−VL3 Bias value Voltage value VL3 = VLCD VL2 = 2/3 VLCD VL1 = 1/3 VLCD VL3 = VLCD VL2 = VL1 = 1/2 VLCD 1/3 bias 1/2 bias NOTE: 1. VLCD is the maximum value of supplied voltage for the LCD panel. • Common Pin and Duty Ratio Control The common pins (COM0−COM7) to be used are determined by duty ratio. Select duty ratio by the duty ratio selection bits (bits 0, 1 and 2 of the LCD mode register1). When reset is released, VCC voltage is output from the common pin. Table 14 Duty ratio control and common pins used Duty ratio selection bits Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 Duty ratio 1 2 3 4 8 VL3 1. Unused common pin outputs the unselected waveform. • Segment Signal Output Pin The segment signal output pins (SEG0−SEG31) are shared with ports P0−P3. When these pins are used as the segment signal output pins, set the direction registers of the corresponding pins to “1”, and set the segment output disable register to “0”. Also, these pins are set to the input port after reset, the V CC voltage is output by the pull-up resistor. Contrast adjust VL3 VL3 R1 VL2 VL2 R4 VL2 VL2 C2 P71/INT11 * C1 P70/INT01 * P71/INT11 * P70/INT01 * R2 VL1 VL1 VL1 VL1 R5 R3 1/3 bias Voltage multiplier is used. 1/3 bias: R1 = R2 = R3 1/3 bias Voltage multiplier is not used. R4 = R5 1/2 bias * : When the voltage multiplier is not used, the C1 and C2 pins function as input ports P70/INT01, P71/INT11. Fig. 45 Example of circuit at each bias (at external power supply input) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 54 of 134 COM0 COM0, COM1 COM0−COM2 COM0−COM3 COM0−COM7 NOTE: Contrast adjust VL3 Common pins used 1/1 bias (static) 38D5 Group • LCD Display RAM The 36-byte area of address 084016 to 086316 is the designated RAM for the LCD display. When “1” is written to these addresses, the corresponding segments of the LCD display panel are turned on. The LCDCK timing frequency (LCD drive timing) is generated internally and the frame frequency can be determined with the following equation; f(LCDCK)= (frequency of count source for LCDCK) (divider division ratio for LCD) Frame frequency= <Notes> (1) Executing STP Instruction Executing the STP instruction sets the LCD enable bit (bit 4 of LCD mode register1 (address 001316)) to “0” and the LCD panel turns off. To turn the LCD panel on after returning from stop mode, set the LCD enable bit to “1”. (2) VL3 Pin To use the LCD drive control circuit while VL3 is set to the voltage equal to VCC, apply the VCC voltage to the VL3 pin and write “1” to the VL3 connection bit (bit 1 of LCD mode register 2 (address 001416)). f(LCDCK) duty ratio at 4COM × 36SEG Bits 7 6 5 4 3 at 8COM × 32SEG 2 1 0 084016 084116 084216 084316 084416 084516 084616 084716 084816 084916 084A16 084B16 084C16 084D16 084E16 084F16 085016 085116 085216 085316 085416 085516 085616 085716 085816 085916 085A16 085B16 085C16 085D16 085E16 085F16 086016 086116 086216 086316 Bits 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Address Address Not used (This area can be used as normal RAM.) SEG0 SEG1 SEG2 SEG3 SEG4 SEG5 SEG6 SEG7 SEG8 SEG9 SEG10 SEG11 SEG12 SEG13 SEG14 SEG15 SEG16 SEG17 SEG18 SEG19 SEG20 SEG21 SEG22 SEG23 SEG24 SEG25 SEG26 SEG27 SEG28 SEG29 SEG30 SEG31 SEG32 SEG33 SEG34 SEG35 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 Fig. 46 LCD display RAM map Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 55 of 134 084016 084116 084216 084316 084416 084516 084616 084716 084816 084916 084A16 084B16 084C16 084D16 084E16 084F16 085016 085116 085216 085316 085416 085516 085616 085716 085816 085916 085A16 085B16 085C16 085D16 085E16 085F16 086016 086116 086216 086316 SEG0 SEG1 SEG2 SEG3 SEG4 SEG5 SEG6 SEG7 SEG8 SEG9 SEG10 SEG11 SEG12 SEG13 SEG14 SEG15 SEG16 SEG17 SEG18 SEG19 SEG20 SEG21 SEG22 SEG23 SEG24 SEG25 SEG26 SEG27 SEG28 SEG29 SEG30 SEG31 Not used (This area can be used as normal RAM.) COM7 COM6 COM5 COM4 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 38D5 Group Internal signal LCDCK timing 1/8 duty Voltage level VL3 VL2 = VL1 VSS COM0 COM1 COM2 COM3 COM4 COM5 COM6 COM7 VL3 VSS SEG0 OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON COM7 COM6 COM5 COM4 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM7 COM6 COM5 COM4 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 1/4 duty VL3 VL2 = VL1 VSS COM0 COM1 COM2 COM3 VL3 VSS SEG0 OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 1/3 duty VL3 VL2 = VL1 VSS COM0 COM1 COM2 VL3 VSS SEG0 ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON ON OFF COM0 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM2 COM1 COM0 1/2 duty VL3 VL2 = VL1 VSS COM0 COM1 VL3 VSS SEG0 ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 Fig. 47 LCD drive waveform (1/2 bias) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 56 of 134 38D5 Group Internal signal LCDCK timing Voltage level 1/8 duty VL3 VL2 VL1 VSS COM0 COM1 COM2 COM3 COM4 COM5 COM6 COM7 VL3 SEG0 VSS OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON COM7 COM6 COM5 COM4 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM7 COM6 COM5 COM4 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 1/4 duty VL3 VL2 VL1 VSS COM0 COM1 COM2 COM3 VL3 SEG0 VSS OFF ON OFF ON OFF OFF ON ON COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 1/3 duty VL3 VL2 VL1 VSS COM0 COM1 COM2 VL3 SEG0 VSS ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON COM0 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM2 COM1 COM0 COM2 COM1 COM0 1/2 duty VL3 VL2 VL1 VSS COM0 COM1 VL3 SEG0 VSS ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 COM1 COM0 Fig. 48 LCD drive waveform (1/3 bias) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 57 of 134 38D5 Group ROM CORRECTION FUNCTION A part of program in ROM can be corrected. Set the start address of the corrected ROM data (i.e. an Op code address of the beginning instruction) to the ROM correction address high-order and low-order registers. When the program is being executed and the value of the program counter matches with the set address value in the ROM correction address registers, the program is branched to the ROM correction vectors and then the correction program can be executed by setting it to the ROM correction vectors. Use the JMP instruction (3-byte instruction) to return the main program from the correction program. The correctable area is up to two. There are two vectors for ROM correction. Also, ROM correction vector can be selected from the RAM area or ROM area by the ROM correction memory selection bit. ROM correction address 1 high-order register (RCA1H) 0FF816 ROM correction address 1 low-order register (RCA1L) 0FF916 ROM correction address 2 high-order register (RCA2H) 0FFA16 ROM correction address 2 low-order register (RCA2L) 0FFB16 Note: Do not set address other than ROM area. Fig. 49 ROM correction address register 000016 SFR area Zero page 004016 Vector 1 Vector 2 RAM area RC2 = “0” address 010016 address 012016 ROM area RC2 = “1” address F10016 address F12016 RAM 010016 ROM correction vector 1 012016 ROM correction vector 2 063F16 The ROM correction function is controlled by the ROM correction address 1 enable bit and ROM correction address 2 enable bit. If the ROM correction function is not used, the ROM correction vector may be used as normal RAM/ROM. When using the ROM correction vector as normal RAM/ROM, make sure to set bits 1 and 0 in the ROM correction enable register to “0” (Disable). <Notes> 1. When using the ROM correction function, set the ROM correction address registers and then enable the ROM correction with the ROM correction enable register. 2. Do not set addresses other than the ROM area in the ROM correction address registers. Do not set the same ROM correction addresses in both the ROM correction address registers 1 and ROM correction address registers 2. 3. It is necessary to contain the process for ROM correction in the program. b7 ~ ~ ~ ~ 800016 Reserved ROM area 808016 Protect area 1 EFFF16 F10016 ROM correction vector 1 ROM F12016 ROM correction vector 2 FF0016 Special page FFDB16 FFFF16 Reserved ROM area Interrupt vector area Fig. 50 Memory map of M38D58G8 b0 ROM correction enable register (Address 0FFC 16) RCR ROM correction address 1 enable bit (RC0) 0 : Disable 1 : Enable ROM correction address 2 enable bit (RC1) 0 : Disable 1 : Enable ROM correction memory selection bit (RC2) 0 : Branch to the RAM area 1 : Branch to the ROM area Not used (returns “0” when read) Note: After ROM correction address register is set, set the ROM correction address enable bit to be enabled. Fig. 51 Structure of ROM correction enable register Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 58 of 134 38D5 Group WATCHDOG TIMER The watchdog timer gives a mean of returning to the reset status when a program cannot run on a normal loop (for example, because of a software run-away). The watchdog timer consists of an 8-bit counter. • Initial Value of Watchdog Timer At reset or writing to the watchdog timer control register, each watchdog timer is set to “FF16”. Instructions such as STA, LDM and CLB to generate the write signals can be used. The written data in bits 7, 6 or 5 are not valid, and the above values are set. Bits 7 to 5 can be rewritten only once after releasing reset. After rewriting it is disable to write any data to this bit. This bit becomes “0” after reset. • Standard Operation of Watchdog Timer The watchdog timer is in the stop state at reset and the watchdog timer starts to count down by writing an optional value in the watchdog timer control register. An internal reset occurs at an underflow of the watchdog timer. Then, reset is released after the reset release time is elapsed, the program starts from the reset vector address. Normally, writing to the watchdog timer control register before an underflow of the watchdog timer is programmed. If writing to the watchdog timer control register is not executed, the watchdog timer does not operate. When reading the watchdog timer control register is executed, the contents of the high-order 5-bit counter, the count source selection bit 2 (bit 5), the STP instruction function selection bit (bit 6), and the count source selection bit (bit 7) are read out. (1) “0” Data bus “0” 1/1024 On-chip oscillator 1/4 “1” <Notes> 1. The watchdog timer continues to count even during the wait time set by timer 1 and timer 2 to release the stop state and in the wait mode. Accordingly, write to the watchdog timer control register to not underflow the watchdog timer in this time. 2. When the on-chip oscillator is selected by the watchdog timer count source selection bit 2, the on-chip oscillator forcibly oscillates and it cannot be stopped. Also, in this time, set the STP instruction function selection bit to “1” at this time. Select “0” (φSOURCE) the watchdog timer count source selection bit 2 at the system which on-chip oscillator is stopped. Watchdog timer count source selection bit Watchdog timer count source selection bit 2 φ SOURCE • Bit 6 of Watchdog Timer Control Register 1. When bit 6 of the watchdog timer control register is “0”, the MCU enters the stop mode by execution of STP instruction. Just after releasing the stop mode, the watchdog timer restarts counting (Note 1). When executing the WIT instruction, the watchdog timer does not stop. 2. When bit 6 is “1”, execution of STP instruction causes an internal reset. When this bit is set to “1” once, it cannot be rewritten to “0” by program. Bit 6 is “0” at reset. 3. The time until the underflow of the watchdog timer register after writing to the watchdog timer control register is executed is as follows (when the bit 7 of the watchdog timer control register is “0”); 4. at XIN mode (f(XIN) = 8 MHz): 32.768 ms 5. at low-speed mode (f(XCIN) = 32 KHz): 8.19s “1” 1/4 Watchdog timer L (3) Watchdog timer H (5) “FF16” is set when watchdog timer control register is written to. Undefined instruction Reset STP instruction function selection bit Reset circuit STP instruction RESET Internal reset Wait until reset release Note1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode Fig. 52 Block diagram of Watchdog timer b7 b0 Watchdog timer control register (WDTCON : address 002916) Watchdog timer H (for read-out of high-order 5 bit) “FF16” is set to watchdog timer by writing to these bits. Watchdog timer count source selection bit 2 0 : φSOURCE (1) 1 : On-chip oscillator/4 STP instruction function selection bit 0 : Entering stop mode by execution of STP instruction 1 : Internal reset by execution of STP instruction Watchdog timer count source selection bit 0 : Count source/1024 1 : Count source/4 Fig. 53 Structure of Watchdog timer control register Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 59 of 134 Notes 1: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4 , or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode 2: When the on-chip oscillator is selected by the watchdog timer count source selection bit 2, set the STP instruction function selection bit to “1”. Select φ(SOURCE) as the count source at the system which on-chip oscillator is stopped. 3: Bits 7 to 5 can be rewritten only once after reset. After rewriting it is disable to write any data to this bit. 38D5 Group CLOCK OUTPUT FUNCTION A system clock φ can be output from I/O port P72. The triple function of I/O port, timer 2 output function and system clock φ output function are controlled by the clock output control register (address 0FF316) and the timer 2 output selection bit of the timer 12 mode register (address 002516). In order to output a system clock φ from I/O port P72, set the timer 2 output selection bit to “1” and P72 clock output control bits of the clock output control register to “01”. In order to output the same signal as oscillation frequency of sub clock XCIN, set the P72 clock output control bits to “10”. When the clock output function is selected, a clock is output while the direction register of port P72 is set to the output mode. P72 is switched to the port output or the output (timer 2 output or the clock output) except port at the cycle after the timer 2 output selection bit is switched. b7 b0 Clock output control register (CKOUT : address 0FF316) P72 clock output control bits b1b0 0 0: Timer 2 output 0 1: φ frequency signal output 1 0: XCIN frequency signal output 1 1: Not available Not used (returns “0” when read) Fig. 54 Structure of clock output control register Timer 2 output selection bit T2OUT output edge switch bit Timer 2 latch (8) Timer 2 (8) S 1/2 T Q “0” “1” Q P72/T2OUT/CKOUT “00” P72 latch P72 direction register System clock φ Timer 2 output selection bit “01” b7 XCIN b0 Timer 12 mode register (address 002516) T12M “10” Timer 2 output selection bit 0 : I/O port 1 : Timer 2 output P72 clock output control bits Fig. 55 Block diagram of Clock output function Other function registers [RRF register (RRFR)] The RRF register (address 001216) is the 8-bit register and does not have the control function. As for the value written in this register, high-order 4 bits and low-order 4 bits interchange. It is initialized after reset. b7 b0 RRF register (RRFR : address 001216) DB4 data storage DB5 data storage DB6 data storage DB7 data storage DB0 data storage DB1 data storage DB2 data storage DB3 data storage Fig. 56 Structure of RRF register Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 60 of 134 38D5 Group RESET CIRCUIT To reset the microcomputer, RESET pin should be held at an “L” level for 2 µs or more. Then the RESET pin is returned to an “H” level (the power source voltage should be between VCC (min.) and 5.5 V), reset is released. After the reset is completed, the program starts from the address contained in address FFFD 16 (high-order byte) and address FFFC16 (low-order byte). Make sure that the reset input voltage meets VIL spec. When a power source voltage passes VCC (min.). In the flash memory version, input to the RESET pin in the following procedure. • When power source is stabilized (1) Input “L” level for 2µs or more to RESET pin. (2) Input “H” level to RESET pin. • At power-on (1) Input “L” level to RESET pin. (2) Increase the power source voltage to 2.7 V. (3) Wait for td(P-R) until internal power source has stabilized. (4) Input “H” level to RESET pin. In the QzROM version, the input level applied to the OSCSEL pin is determined when the RESET pin changes from “L” to “H”. VCC VCC (min.) 0V VCC RESET RESET 0.2VCC or less 0V (1) 5V VCC 2.7 V 0V 5V RESET 0V VCC RESET td(P-R) or more Power source voltage detection circuit Note 1: QzROM version: 2 µs or more Flash memory version: td(P-R) or more Fig. 57 Reset circuit example OSCSEL=L: OCO OSCSEL=H: XIN ······ System clock φ RESET Internal reset Reset address from vector table Address ? Data ? ? ? FFFC ADL FFFD ADH, ADL ADH SYNC OSCSEL=L: OCO= about 32768 cycles OSCSEL=H: XIN= about 8192 cycles Notes 1: The frequency of system clock φ is f(OCO)/32 or f(XIN)/8. 2: The question marks (?) indicate an undefined state. 3: In the QzROM version, the input level applied to the OSCSEL pin is determined when the RESET pin changes from “L” to “H”. Fig. 58 Reset sequence Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 61 of 134 38D5 Group Address 000016 Register contents 0016 (36) Timer X (low-order) Port P0 direction register 000116 0016 Port P1 000216 0016 (4) Port P1 direction register 000316 (5) Port P2 (6) Address 002A16 Register contents FF16 (37) Timer X (high-order) 002B16 FF16 (38) Timer X (extension) 002C16 0016 0016 (39) Timer X mode register 002D16 0016 000416 0016 (40) Timer X control register 1 002E16 0016 Port P2 direction register 000516 0016 (41) Timer X control register 2 002F16 0016 (7) Port P3 000616 0016 (42) Compare register 1 (low-order) 003016 0016 (8) Port P3 direction register 000716 0016 (43) Compare register 1 (high-order) 003116 0016 (9) Port P4 000816 0016 (44) Compare register 2 (low-order) 003216 0016 (10) Port P4 direction register 000916 0016 (45) Compare register 2 (high-order) 003316 0016 (11) Port P5 000A16 0016 (46) Compare register 3 (low-order) 003416 0016 (12) Port P5 direction register 000B16 0016 (47) Compare register 3 (high-order) 003516 0016 (13) Port P6 000C16 0016 (48) Timer Y (low-order) 003616 FF16 (14) Port P6 direction register 000D16 0016 (49) Timer Y (high-order) 003716 FF16 (15) Port P7 000E16 0016 (50) Timer Y mode register 003816 0016 (16) Port P7 direction register 000F16 0016 (51) Timer Y control register 003916 0016 (17) CPU mode register 2 (52) Interrupt edge selection register 003A16 0016 (18) RRF register 001116 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 * 0016 001216 (53) CPU mode register (19) LCD mode register 1 001316 0016 (54) Interrupt request register 1 003B16 * 1 * 0 0 0 0 0 0016 003C16 (20) LCD mode register 2 001416 0016 (55) Interrupt request register 2 003D16 0016 (21) AD control register 001516 0816 (56) Interrupt control register 1 003E16 0016 (22) Serial I/O1 status register 001916 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0016 001A16 (57) Interrupt control register 2 003F16 0016 (58) PULL register 1 0FF016 0016 (59) PULL register 2 0FF116 0016 (25) Serial I/O2 control register 001B16 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0016 001D16 (60) PULL register 3 0FF216 0016 (26) Timer 1 002016 FF16 (61) Clock output control register 0FF316 0016 (27) Timer 2 002116 0116 (62) Segment output disable register 0 0FF416 FF16 (28) Timer 3 002216 FF16 (63) Segment output disable register 1 0FF516 FF16 (29) Timer 4 002316 FF16 (64) Segment output disable register 2 0FF616 0F16 (30) PWM01 register 002416 0016 (65) Key input control register 0FF716 0016 (31) Timer 12 mode register 002516 0016 (66) ROM correction address 1(high-order) 0FF816 0016 (32) Timer 34 mode register (33) Timer 1234 mode register 002616 0016 (67) ROM correction address 1(low-order) 0FF916 0016 002716 0016 (68) ROM correction address 2 (high-order) 0FFA16 0016 1234 frequency division (34) Timer selection register 002816 0016 (69) ROM correction address 2 (low-order) 0FFB16 0016 (70) ROM correction enable register 0016 (1) Port P0 (2) (3) (23) Serial I/O1 control register (24) UART control register (35) Watchdog timer control register 002916 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 (71) Processor status register (72) Program counter 0FFC16 (PS) × × × × × 1 × × (PCH) FFFD16 contents (PCL) FFFC16 contents ×: Not fixed *: Depends on OSCSEL setting at the QzROM version. In the flash memory version, the CPU mode register 2 (address 001116), is set to “0016” and the CPU mode register (address 003B16) is set to “E016”. Since the initial values for other than above mentioned registers and RAM contents are indefinite at reset, they must be set. Fig. 59 Internal status at reset Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 62 of 134 38D5 Group CLOCK GENERATING CIRCUIT The oscillation circuit of 38D5 Group can be formed by connecting an oscillator, capacitor and resistor between XIN and XOUT (XCIN and XCOUT). To supply a clock signal externally, input it to the XIN pin and make the XOUT pin open. The clocks that are externally generated cannot be directly input to XCIN. Use the circuit constants in accordance with the oscillator manufacturer's recommended values. No external resistor is needed between XIN and XOUT since a feed-back resistor exists on-chip. (An external feed-back resistor may be needed depending on conditions.) However, an about 10 MΩ external feedback resistor is needed between XCIN and XCOUT. The 38D5 Group operation mode immediately after reset depends on the OSCSEL pin state in the QzROM version. When the OSCSEL pin state is GND level, the only on-chip oscillator starts oscillating. The XIN -X OUT oscillation stops oscillating, and XCIN and X COUT pins function as I/O ports. Flash memory version as same. When the OSCSEL pin state is V CC level, the X IN -X OUT oscillation divided by 8 starts oscillating. The on-chip oscillator stops oscillating, and the XCIN and XCOUT pins function as I/O ports. Note the following in each mode. • XIN Mode The XIN-XOUT oscillation does not stop even if the XIN-XOUT oscillation stop bit is set to “1”. • Low-Speed Mode The XCIN-XCOUT oscillation stops if the port XC switch bit is set to “0”. • On-Chip Oscillator Mode Even if the on-chip oscillator stop bit is set to “1”, the on-chip oscillator oscillation does not stop in the flash memory version, but stops in the QzROM version. • Frequency Control (1) On-chip oscillation mode The system clock φ is the on-chip oscillator oscillation divided by 32. (2) XIN mode Frequency/2 mode, frequency/4 mode, and frequency/8 mode are collectively referred as XIN mode. - Frequency/8 Mode The system clock φ is the frequency of XIN divided by 8. - Frequency/4 Mode The system clock φ is the frequency of XIN divided by 4. - Frequency/2 Mode The system clock φ is half the frequency of XIN. (3)Low-speed Mode The system clock φ is half the frequency of sub clock. After reset and when system returns from the stop mode, the operation mode depends on the OSCSEL pin state in the QzROM version and the flash memory version operation mode is the on-chip oscillator mode. When the RESET pin changes from “L” to “H” and when the STP instruction is executed, determine the input level applied to the OSCSEL pin. Refer to the clock state transition diagram for the setting of transition to each mode. The XIN-OUT oscillation is controlled by the bit 5 of CPUM, and the sub-clock oscillation is controlled by the bit 4 of CPUM and the on-chip oscillator oscillation is controlled by the bit 0 of CPUM2. In the on-chip oscillator mode, the oscillation by the oscillator can be stopped. In the low-speed mode, the power consumption can be reduced by stopping the XIN−XOUT oscillation. In low-speed mode, the on-chip oscillator stops in the QzROM version regardless of the on-chip oscillator stop bit value. The on-chip oscillator does not stop in the flash memory version, so set the on-chip oscillator stop bit to “1” to stop the oscillation. Set enough time for oscillation to stabilize by programming to restart the stopped oscillation and switch the operation mode. Also, set enough time for oscillation to stabilize by programming to switch the timer count source. <Notes on Clock Generating Circuit> If you switch the mode between on-chip oscillator mode, XIN mode and low-speed mode, stabilize both X IN and X CIN oscillations. Especially be careful immediately after power-on and at returning from stop mode. Refer to the clock state transition diagram for the setting of transition to each mode. Set the frequency in the condition that f(XIN) > 3•f(XCIN). When the X IN mode is not used (X IN -X OUT oscillation and external clock input are not performed), connect XIN to VCC through a resistor. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 63 of 134 38D5 Group • Oscillation Control (1) Stop Mode If the STP instruction is executed, the system clock φ stops at an “H” level, and main clock and sub-clock oscillators stop. In this time, values set previously to timer 1 latch and timer 2 latch are loaded automatically to timer 1 and timer 2. Set the values * to generate the wait time required for oscillation stabilization to timer 1 latch and timer 2 latch (low-order 8 bits of timer 1 and high-order 8 bits of timer 2) before the STP instruction. The frequency divider for timer 1 is used for the timer 1 count source, and the output of timer 1 is forcibly connected to timer 2. In this time, bits 0 to 5 of the timer 12 mode register are cleared to “0”. The values of the timer 12 frequency divider selection register are not changed. Set the interrupt enable bits of the timer 1 and timer 2 to be disabled (“0”) before executing the STP instruction. *: Reference (Set values according to your oscillator and system.) OSCSEL = “L” of the QzROM version and flash memory version: .......................................................................... 000516 or more OSCSEL = “H” of the QzROM version: ..........................................................................01FF16 or more When an external interrupt is received, the clock set according to the OSCSEL pin state starts oscillating in the QzROM version. The operation mode at returning is decided by the clock that set according to the OSCSEL pin state. Bits 3, 5, 6, and 7 of CPUM and bit 0 of CPUM2 are forcibly changed by the OSCSEL pin state. In the flash memory version, the on-chip oscillator starts oscillating and the operation mode at returning is set to on-chip oscillator mode. The bit 3 of CPUM is changed to “0”, bits 5, 6 and 7 of CPUM are changed to “1”, and the bit 0 of CPUM2 is changed to “0” forcibly. Oscillator restarts when reset occurs or an interrupt request is received, but the system clock φ is not supplied to the CPU until timer 2 underflows. This allows time for the clock circuit oscillation to stabilize. (2) Wait Mode If the WIT instruction is executed, only the system clock φ stops at an “H” state. The states of main clock, on-chip oscillator and sub clock are the same as the state before executing the WIT instruction, and oscillation does not stop. Since supply of system clock φ is started immediately after the interrupt is received, the instruction can be executed immediately. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 64 of 134 XCIN XCOUT Rf XIN Rd Rd CCOUT CCIN XOUT CIN COUT Note : Insert a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator and the oscillation drive capacity setting. Use the value recommended by the maker of the oscillator. Also, if the oscillator manufacturer's data sheet specifies that a feedback resistor be added external to the chip though a feedback resistor exists on-chip, insert a feedback resistor between XIN and XOUT following the instruction. Fig. 60 Ceramic resonator circuit example XCIN XCOUT Rf XIN XOUT Open Rd External oscillation circuit CCIN CCOUT VCC VSS Fig. 61 External clock input circuit 38D5 Group On-chip oscillator CPUM2 BIT0 On-chip oscillator stop bit “0” 1/4 XIN XOUT Main clock division ratio selection bit CPUM BIT7, 6 (2) “11” “00” “01” “10” XIN-XOUT oscillation stop bit CPUM BIT5 XCOUT XCIN “0” Internal system clock selection bit CPUM BIT3 (1) “1” φSOURCE Timer 1 count source selection bits “01” (3) Timer 1 Frequency divider for Timer 1/2 Timer 2 “00” “10” 1/2 1/2 “1” “1” Port Xc switch bit CPUM BIT4 Timer 2 count source selection bits “00” “0” Main clock division ratio selection bit “0” CPUM BIT6 “0” Internal system clock selection bit “1” System clock φ Q S R S STP instruction WIT instruction R Q Q S R STP instruction Reset Interrupt disable flag I Interrupt request Notes 1: When the XCIN-XCOUT oscillation is selected as the system clock, set the port Xc switch bit to “1”. 2: Although a feed-back resistor exists on-chip, an external feed-back resistor may be needed depending on conditions. 3: φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode •Sub-clock in the low-speed mode However, when used as the A/D conversion clock by the A/D converter, φSOURCE indicates the followings: •XIN input in the frequency/2, 4, or 8 mode •On-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the low-speed or the on-chip oscillator mode Fig. 62 Clock generating circuit block diagram Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 65 of 134 38D5 Group Low-speed mode (14) On-chip oscillator mode XIN stop XCIN stop OCO oscillation φ =f(OCO)/32 CM7=1 CM6=1 CM5=1 CM4=0 CM3=0 CM8=0 CM5 • QzROM version • Flash memory version OSCSEL=L XIN oscillation XCIN stop OCO oscillation φ =f(OCO)/32 CM7=1 CM6=1 CM5=0 CM4=0 CM3=0 CM8=0 CM4 CM4 CM5 CM4 XIN stop XCIN oscillation OCO oscillation φ =f(OCO)/32 CM7=1 CM6=1 CM5=1 CM4=1 CM3=0 CM8=0 CM3, CM8 (6) XIN stop XCIN oscillation OCO stop φ =f(XCIN)/2 CM7=1 (invalid) CM6=1 (invalid) CM5=1 CM4=1 CM3=1 CM8=1 CM5 (CM7) CM5 XIN oscillation XCIN oscillation OCO oscillation φ =f(OCO)/32 CM7=1 CM6=1 CM5=0 CM4=1 CM3=0 CM8=0 CM3, CM7, CM8 (6) XIN oscillation XCIN oscillation OCO stop φ =f(XCIN)/2 CM7=0 (invalid) CM6=1 (invalid) CM5=0 CM4=1 CM3=1 CM8=1 CM6 (CM7) CM6 Reset release (6) CM7 (6) CM7 CM3 Frequency/8 mode • QzROM version OSCSEL=H XIN oscillation (frequency/8) XCIN stop OCO oscillation or stop CM4 φ =f(XIN)/8 CM7=0 CM6=1 CM5=0 CM4=0 CM3=0 CM8=∗ XIN oscillation (frequency/8) XCIN oscillation OCO oscillation or stop φ =f(XIN)/8 CM7=0 CM6=1 CM5=0 CM4=1 CM3=0 CM8=∗ CM6 CM5 CM6 CM5 (CM7) XIN oscillation XCIN oscillation OCO stop φ =f(XCIN)/2 CM7=1 (invalid) CM6=0 (invalid) CM5=0 CM4=1 CM3=1 CM8=1 XIN oscillation XCIN oscillation OCO stop φ =f(XCIN)/2 CM7=0 (invalid) CM6=0 (invalid) CM5=0 CM4=1 CM3=1 CM8=1 CM3 CM3 CM6 CM7 CM6 CM6 CM6 CM7 Frequency/4 mode Frequency/2 mode XIN oscillation (frequency/2) XCIN stop OCO oscillation or stop φ =f(XIN)/2 CM7=0 CM6=0 CM5=0 CM4=0 CM3=0 CM8=∗ CM4 XIN oscillation (frequency/2) XCIN oscillation OCO oscillation or stop φ =f(XIN)/2 CM7=0 CM6=0 CM5=0 CM4=1 CM3=0 CM8=∗ XIN oscillation (frequency/4) XCIN stop OCO oscillation or stop φ =f(XIN)/4 CM7=1 CM6=0 CM5=0 CM4=0 CM3=0 CM8=∗ XIN oscillation (frequency/4) XCIN oscillation OCO oscillation or stop φ =f(XIN)/4 CM7=1 CM6=0 CM5=0 CM4=1 CM3=0 CM8=∗ CM4 ∗ : The OCO oscillating at “0”; the OCO stopped at “1”. b7 Notes 1: Switch the mode by the arrows shown between the mode blocks. The all modes can be switched to the stop mode or the wait mode. 2: Timer and LCD operate in the wait mode. System is returned to the source mode when the wait mode is ended. 3: The CM4 value is retained in the stop mode. When the stop mode is ended, the operation mode varies as follows: In the QzROM version: Mode set by the OSCSEL pin state In the flash memory version: On-chip oscillator mode The input level applied to the OSCSEL pin is determined when executing the STP instruction. 4: Before executing the STP instruction, set the values to generate the wait time required for oscillation stabilization to timer 1 and timer 2, and set to “0” (interrupts disabled) to the interrupt enable bits of timer 1 and timer 2. 5: Execute the transition after the oscillation used in the destination mode is stabilized. 6: When system goes to on-chip oscillator mode, the oscillation stabilizing wait time is not needed. 7: The on-chip oscillator can be stopped in all kinds of state of frequency/2,4 mode. 8: In all XIN mode, stop of on-chip oscillator is enabled. 9: The example assumes that 8 MHz is being applied to the X IN pin and 32 kHz to the XCIN pin. f(OCO) indicates the oscillation frequency of on-chip oscillator. 10: When selecting the on-chip oscillator for the WDT clock, the on-chip oscillator does not stop. Also, in low-speed mode, the on-chip oscillator stops in the QzROM version regardless of the on-chip oscillator stop bit value. The onchip oscillator does not stop in the flash memory version, so set this bit to “1” to stop the oscillation. In on-chip oscillator mode, even if this bit is set to “1”, the on-chip oscillator oscillation does not stop in the flash memory version, but stops in the QzROM version. 11: In low-speed mode, the X CIN-XCOUT oscillation stops if the port X C switch bit is set to “0”. 12: In XIN mode, the XIN-XOUT oscillation does not stop even if the X INXOUT oscillation stop bit is set to “1”. 13: 12.5 MHz < f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz is not available in the frequency/2 mode. 14: In the flash memory version, set the on-chip oscillator stop bit to “1” (oscillation stops) because OCO is in the state set by the setting value of the on-chip oscillator stop bit. Fig. 63 State transitions of system clock Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 66 of 134 b0 CM8 CPU mode register 2 CPUM2 (address 001116,QzROM version, OSCSEL=L, initial value: 0016) ( QzROM version, OSCSEL=H,initial value: 0116) ( Flash memory version, initial value: 0016) On-chip oscillator stop bit 0 : Oscillating 1 : Stopped Not used (do not write “1”) Not used (returns “0” when read) Not used (do not write “1”) b7 b0 CM7 CM6 CM5 CM4 CM3 CM2 CM1 CM0 CPU mode register CPUM (address 003B16, QzROM version, OSCSEL=L, initial value: E016) ( QzROM version, OSCSEL=H, initial value: 4016) ( Flash memory version, initial value: E016) Processor mode bits b1 b0 0 0 : Single-chip mode 0 1: 1 0 : Not available 1 1: Stack page selection bit 0 : 0 page 1 : 1 page Internal system clock selection bit 0 : Main clock selected (includes OCO, XIN) 1 : XCIN–XCOUT selected Port Xc switch bit (11) 0 : I/O port function (Oscillation stop) 1 : XCIN–XCOUT oscillating function XIN–XOUT oscillation stop bit (12) 0 : Oscillating 1 : Stopped Main clock division ratio selection bit (Valid only when CM3=0) (13) b7 b8 0 0 1 1 0 : f(XIN)/2 (frequency/2 mode) 1 : f(XIN)/8 (frequency/8 mode) 0 : f(XIN)/4 (frequency/4 mode) 1 : On-chip oscillator 38D5 Group QzROM Writing Mode In the QzROM writing mode, the user ROM area can be rewritten while the microcomputer is mounted on-board by using a serial programmer which is applicable for this microcomputer. Table 15 lists the pin description (QzROM writing mode) and Figure 64 and Figure 65 show the pin connections. Refer to Figure 66 to Figure 69 for examples of a connection with a serial programmer. Contact the manufacturer of your serial programmer for serial programmer. Refer to the user ’s manual of your serial programmer for details on how to use it. Table 15 Pin description (QzROM writing mode) Pin VCC, VSS RESET XIN XOUT VREF AVSS P00−P07 P10−P17 P20−P27 P33−P37 P40, P44−P47 P50−P57 P60−P67 P72−P74 P70, P71 OSCSEL P41 P42 P43 Name Power source Reset input Clock input Clock output Analog reference voltage Analog power source I/O port Input port VPP input ESDA input/output ESCLK input ESPGMB input Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 I/O Input Input Input Output Input Function • Apply 2.7 to 5.5 V to VCC, and 0 V to VSS. • Reset input pin for active “L”. Reset occurs when RESET pin is held at an “L” level for 16 cycles or more of XIN. • Set the same termination as the single-chip mode. • Input the reference voltage of A/D converter to VREF. Input I/O • Connect AVss to Vss. • Input “H” or “L” level signal or leave the pin open. Input Input I/O Input Input • Input “H” or “L” level signal or leave the pin open. • QzROM programmable power source pin. • Serial data I/O pin. • Serial clock input pin. • Read/program pulse input pin. Page 67 of 134 Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 68 of 134 Fig. 64 Pin connection diagram (M38D5XGXFP) P7 3/PWM 0/T 3OUT P7 2/T 2OUT /CKOUT VL 3 VL 2 P7 1/C 2/INT 11 P7 0/C 1 /INT 01 VL 1 RESET Vcc PRQP0080GB-A(80P6N-A) 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 73 9 72 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 P47/SRDY2/(KW3) P46/SCLK2/(KW2) P45/SOUT2/(KW1) P44/SIN2/(KW0) ESPGMB P43/SRDY1 P42/SCLK1 ESCLK P41/TXD ESDA P40/RXD AVSS VREF P57/AN7/ADKEY0 P56/AN6 P55/AN5 P54/AN4 P53/AN3 P52/AN2 P6 2 /INT 00/(LED 0) OSCSEL RESET P6 1/X COUT P6 0/X CIN V SS X IN X OUT V CC P7 4/PWM 1 /T 4OUT P5 1/AN 1/RTP 1 P5 0/AN 0/RTP 0 P6 7/CNTR 1/(LED 5) P6 6/INT 10 /CNTR 0/(LED 4) P6 5/T XOUT1/(LED 3) P6 4/INT 2/(LED 2) P6 3/T XOUT2/(LED 1) 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 P2 0/SEG 0/(KW 4) P2 1/SEG 1/(KW 5) P2 2/SEG 2 /(KW 6) P2 3/SEG 3 /(KW 7) P2 4/SEG 4 P2 5/SEG 5 P2 6/SEG 6 P2 7/SEG 7 P0 0/SEG 8 P0 1/SEG 9 P0 2/SEG 10 P0 3/SEG 11 P0 4/SEG 12 P0 5/SEG 13 P0 6/SEG 14 P0 7/SEG 15 P1 0/SEG 16 P1 1/SEG 17 P1 2/SEG 18 P1 3/SEG 19 P1 4/SEG 20 P1 5/SEG 21 P1 6/SEG 22 P1 7/SEG 23 38D5 Group M38D5XGXFP QzROM version 65 40 66 39 67 38 68 37 69 36 70 35 71 34 32 33 74 31 75 76 30 29 77 28 78 27 79 26 80 25 GND : QzROM pin P30/SEG24 P31/SEG25 P32/SEG26 P33/SEG27 P34/SEG28 P35/SEG29 P36/SEG30 P37/SEG31 COM7/SEG32 COM6/SEG33 COM5/SEG34 COM4/SEG35 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 * VPP * : Connect to oscillation circuit. 38D5 Group 41 42 43 45 44 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 P2 2/SEG 2/(KW 6) P2 3/SEG 3/(KW 7) P2 4/SEG 4 P2 5/SEG 5 P2 6/SEG 6 P2 7/SEG 7 P0 0/SEG 8 P0 1/SEG 9 P0 2/SEG 10 P0 3/SEG 11 P0 4/SEG 12 P0 5/SEG 13 P0 6/SEG 14 P0 7/SEG 15 P1 0/SEG 16 P1 1/SEG 17 P1 2/SEG 18 P1 3/SEG 19 P1 4/SEG 20 P1 5/SEG 21 QzROM version P21/SEG1/(KW5) P20/SEG0/(KW4) P47/SRDY2/(KW3) P46/SCLK2/(KW2) P45/SOUT2/(KW1) P44/SIN2/(KW0) ESPGMB P43/SRDY1 P42/SCLK1 ESCLK P41/TXD ESDA P40/RXD AVSS VREF P57/AN7/ADKEY0 P56/AN6 P55/AN5 P54/AN4 P53/AN3 P52/AN2 P51/AN1/RTP1 61 40 62 39 63 38 64 37 65 36 66 35 67 34 68 33 69 32 P50/AN0/RTP0 M38D5XGXHP 70 71 31 30 72 29 73 28 74 27 75 26 20 19 18 17 16 P7 3/PWM 0/T 3OUT P7 2 /T 2OUT/CKOUT VL 3 VL 2 P7 1 /C 2/NT 11 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 P6 7/CNTR 1/(LED 5) P6 6 /INT 10/CNTR 0/(LED 4) P6 5/T XOUT1/(LED 3) P6 4 /INT 2/(LED 2) P6 3/T XOUT2/(LED 1) P6 2/INT 00/(LED 0) OSCSEL RESET P6 1/X COUT P6 0/X CIN V SS X IN X OUT V CC P7 4/PWM 1/T 4OUT 7 21 6 22 80 5 23 79 4 78 3 24 2 25 77 1 76 P16/SEG22 P17/SEG23 P30/SEG24 P31/SEG25 P32/SEG26 P33/SEG27 P34/SEG28 P35/SEG29 P36/SEG30 P37/SEG31 COM7/SEG32 COM6/SEG33 COM5/SEG34 COM4/SEG35 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 VL1 P70/C1/INT01 * VPP RESET * : Connect to oscillation circuit. GND : QzROM pin Vcc PLQP0080KB-A(80P6Q-A) Fig. 65 Pin connection diagram (M38D5XGXHP) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 69 of 134 38D5 Group QzROM version 38D5 Group Vcc Vcc OSCSEL 4.7 kΩ 4.7 kΩ P41 (ESDA) P42 (ESCLK) P43 (ESPGMB) 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 RESET circuit ∗1 RESET Vss AVss XIN XOUT Set the same termination as the single-chip mode. ∗1 : Open-collector buffer Note : For the programming circuit, the wiring capacity of each signal pin must not exceed 47 pF. Fig. 66 When using E8 programmer, connection example (1) (OSCSEL = “L”) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 70 of 134 38D5 Group QzROM version 38D5 Group Vcc VCC *2 Jumper switch OSCSEL 4.7 kΩ 4.7 kΩ P41 (ESDA) P42 (ESCLK) P43 (ESPGMB) 14 13 12 11 RESET circuit *1 10 9 8 7 RESET 6 5 Vss 4 3 2 1 AVss XIN XOUT Set the same termination as the single-chip mode. *1 : Open-collector buffer **2 : When programming 38D5 Group is performed, disconnect Vcc from OSCSEL by a jumper switch. Note : For the programming circuit, the wiring capacity of each signal pin must not exceed 47 pF. Fig. 67 When using E8 programmer, connection example (2) (OSCSEL = “H”) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 71 of 134 38D5 Group QzROM version 38D5 Group T_VDD Vcc T_VPP OSCSEL 4.7kΩ 4.7kΩ T_TXD T_RXD P41 (ESDA) T_SCLK P42 (ESCLK) T_BUSY N.C. T_PGM/OE/MD P43 (ESPGMB) RESET circuit RESET T_RESET GND Vss AVss XIN XOUT Set the same termination as the single-chip mode. Note: For the programming circuit, the wiring capacity of each signal pin must not exceed 47 pF. Fig. 68 When using programmer of Suisei Electronics System Co., LTD, connection example (1) (OSCSEL = “L”) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 72 of 134 38D5 Group QzROM version 38D5 Group T_VDD Vcc *1 Jumper switch T_VPP OSCSEL 4.7kΩ 4.7kΩ T_TXD T_RXD P41 (ESDA) T_SCLK P42 (ESCLK) T_BUSY N.C. T_PGM/OE/MD P43 (ESPGMB) RESET circuit RESET T_RESET GND Vss AVss XIN XOUT Set the same termination as the single-chip mode. *1 : When programming QzROM is performed, disconnect Vcc from OSCSEL by a jumper switch. Note: For the programming circuit, the wiring capacity of each signal pin must not exceed 47 pF. Fig. 69 When using programmer of Suisei Electronics System Co., LTD, connection example (2) (OSCSEL = “H”) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 73 of 134 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY MODE The 38D5 Group flash memory version has the flash memory that can be rewritten with a single power source. For this flash memory, three flash memory modes are available in which to read, program, and erase: the parallel I/O and standard serial I/O modes in which the flash memory can be manipulated using a programmer and the CPU rewrite mode in which the flash memory can be manipulated by the Central Processing Unit (CPU). For details of each mode, refer to the next and after pages. Contact the manufacturer of your programmer for the programmer. Refer to the user's manual of your programmer for details on how to use it. This flash memory version has some blocks on the flash memory as shown in Figure 70 and each block can be erased. In addition to the ordinary User ROM area to store the MCU operation control program, the flash memory has a Boot ROM area that is used to store a program to control rewriting in CPU rewrite and standard serial I/O modes. This Boot ROM area has had a standard serial I/O mode control program stored in it when shipped from the factory. However, the user can write a rewrite control program in this area that suits the user’s application system. This Boot ROM area can be rewritten in only parallel I/O mode. Performance overview Table 16 lists the performance overview of the 38D5 Group flash memory version. Table 16 Performance overview of 38D5 Group flash memory version Parameter Power source voltage (Vcc) Program/Erase VPP voltage (VPP) Flash memory mode Erase block division User ROM area/Data ROM area Boot ROM area (1) Program method Erase method Program/Erase control method Number of commands Number of program/Erase times ROM code protection NOTE: Function VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V 3 modes; Parallel I/O mode, Standard serial I/O mode, CPU rewrite mode Refer to Figure 70. Not divided (4K bytes) In units of bytes Block erase Program/Erase control by software command 5 commands 100 Available in parallel I/O mode and standard serial I/O mode 1. The Boot ROM area has had a standard serial I/O mode control program stored in it when shipped from the factory. This Boot ROM area can be erased and written in only parallel I/O mode. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 74 of 134 38D5 Group Boot Mode The control program for CPU rewrite mode must be written into the User ROM or Boot ROM area in parallel I/O mode beforehand. (If the control program is written into the Boot ROM area, the standard serial I/O mode becomes unusable.) See Figure 70 for details about the Boot ROM area. Normal microcomputer mode is entered when the microcomputer is reset with pulling CNVSS pin low. In this case, the CPU starts operating using the control program in the User ROM area. When the microcomputer is reset and the CNVSS pin high after pulling the P41/TxD pin and CNVSS pin high, the CPU starts operating (start address of program is stored into addresses FFFC 16 and FFFD 16 ) using the control program in the Boot ROM area. This mode is called the “Boot mode”. Also, User ROM area can be rewritten using the control program in the Boot ROM area. CPU Rewrite Mode In CPU rewrite mode, the internal flash memory can be operated on (read, program, or erase) under control of the Central Processing Unit (CPU). In CPU rewrite mode, only the User ROM area shown in Figure 70 can be rewritten; the Boot ROM area cannot be rewritten. Make sure the program and block erase commands are issued for only the User ROM area and each block area. The control program for CPU rewrite mode can be stored in either User ROM or Boot ROM area. In the CPU rewrite mode, because the flash memory cannot be read from the CPU, the rewrite control program must be transferred to internal RAM area before it can be executed. Block Address Block addresses refer to the maximum address of each block. These addresses are used in the block erase command. 000016 User ROM area SFR area 100016 004016 Internal RAM area (2K bytes) RAM 140016 Data block B: 1K bytes Data block A: 1K bytes 180016 083F16 Block 1: 26K bytes 0FE016 SFR area Notes1: The boot ROM area can be rewritten in a parallel I/O mode. (Access to except boot ROM area is disabled.) 2: To specify a block, use the maximum address in the block. 3: The QzROM version has the reserved ROM area. Note the difference of the area. 800016 0FFF16 100016 Block 0: 32 K bytes Internal flash memory area (60K bytes) F00016 Boot ROM area 4K bytes FFFF16 FFFF16 Fig 70. Block diagram of built-in flash memory Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 75 of 134 FFFF16 38D5 Group Outline Performance CPU rewrite mode is usable in the single-chip or Boot mode. The only User ROM area can be rewritten. In CPU rewrite mode, the CPU erases, programs and reads the internal flash memory as instructed by software commands. This rewrite control program must be transferred to internal RAM area before it can be executed. The MCU enters CPU rewrite mode by setting “1” to the CPU rewrite mode select bit (bit 1 of address 0FE016). Then, software commands can be accepted. Use software commands to control program and erase operations. Whether a program or erase operation has terminated normally or in error can be verified by reading the status register. Figure 71 shows the flash memory control register 0. Bit 0 of the flash memory control register 0 is the RY/BY status flag used exclusively to read the operating status of the flash memory. During programming and erase operations, it is “0” (busy). Otherwise, it is “1” (ready). Bit 1 of the flash memory control register 0 is the CPU rewrite mode select bit. When this bit is set to “1”, the MCU enters CPU rewrite mode. And then, software commands can be accepted. In CPU rewrite mode, the CPU becomes unable to access the internal flash memory directly. Therefore, use the control program in the internal RAM for write to bit 1. To set this bit 1 to “1”, it is necessary to write “0” and then write “1” in succession to bit 1. The bit can be set to “0” by only writing “0”. Bit 2 of the flash memory control register 0 is the user block 1 E/W enable bit. By setting combination of bit 4 (user block 0 E/W enable bit) of the flash memory control register 2 (address 0FE216) and this bit as shown in Table 17, E/W is disabled to user block in the CPU rewriting mode. Bit 3 of the flash memory control register 0 is the flash memory reset bit used to reset the control circuit of internal flash memory. This bit is used when flash memory access has failed. When the CPU rewrite mode select bit is “1”, setting “1” for this bit resets the control circuit. To release the reset, it is necessary to set this bit to “0”. Bit 5 of the flash memory control register 0 is the User ROM area select bit and is valid only in the boot mode. Setting this bit to “1” in the boot mode switches an accessible area from the boot ROM area to the user ROM area. To use the CPU rewrite mode in the boot mode, set this bit to “1”. To rewrite bit 5, execute the user original reprogramming control software transferred to the internal RAM in advance. Bit 6 of the flash memory control register 0 is the program status flag. This bit is set to “1” when writing to flash memory is failed. When program error occurs, the block cannot be used. Bit 7 of the flash memory control register 0 is the erase status flag. This bit is set to “1” when erasing flash memory is failed. When erase error occurs, the block cannot be used. Figure 72 shows the flash memory control register 1. Bit 0 of the flash memory control register 1 is the Erase suspend enable bit. By setting this bit to “1”, the erase suspend mode to suspend erase processing temporary when block erase command is executed can be used. In order to set this bit 0 to “1”, writing “0” and “1” in succession to bit 0. In order to set this bit to “0”, write “0” only to bit 0. Bit 1 of the flash memory control register 1 is the erase suspend request bit. By setting this bit to “1” when erase suspend enable bit is “1”, the erase processing is suspended. Bit 6 of the flash memory control register 1 is the erase suspend flag. This bit is cleared to “0” at the flash erasing. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 76 of 134 b7 b0 Flash memory control register 0 (FMCR0: address : 0FE016, initial value: 0116) RY/BY status flag 0 : Busy (being written or erased) 1 : Ready CPU rewrite mode select bit(1) 0 : CPU rewrite mode invalid 1 : CPU rewrite mode valid User block 1 E/W enable bit(1, 2) 0 : E/W disabled (180016-7FFF16) 1 : E/W enabled (180016-7FFF16) Flash memory reset bit(3, 4) 0 : Normal operation 1 : reset Not used (do not write “1” to this bit.) User ROM area select bit(5) 0 : Boot ROM area is accessed 1 : User ROM area is accessed Program status flag 0: Pass 1: Error Erase status flag 0: Pass 1: Error Notes 1: For this bit to be set to “1”, the user needs to write a “0” and then a “1” to it in succession. For this bit to be set to “0”, write “0” only to this bit. 2: This bit can be written only when CPU rewrite mode select bit is “1”. 3: Effective only when the CPU rewrite mode select bit = “1”. Fix this bit to “0” when the CPU rewrite mode select bit is “0”. 4: When setting this bit to “1” (when the control circuit of flash memory is reset), the flash memory cannot be accessed for 10 ms. 5: Write to this bit in program on RAM Fig 71. Structure of flash memory control register 0 b7 b0 Flash memory control register 1 (FMCR1: address: 0FE116, initial value: 4016) Erase Suspend enable bit(1) 0 : Suspend invalid 1 : Suspend valid Erase Suspend request bit(2) 0 : Erase restart 1 : Suspend request Not used (do not write “1” to this bit.) Erase Suspend flag 0 : Erase active 1 : Erase inactive (Erase Suspend mode) Not used (do not write “1” to this bit.) Notes 1: For this bit to be set to “1”, the user needs to write a “0” and then a “1” to it in succession. For this bit to be set to “0”, write “0” only to this bit. 2: Effective only when the suspend enable bit = “1”. Fig 72. Structure of flash memory control register 1 38D5 Group b7 b0 Flash memory control register 2 (FMCR2: address : 0FE216, initial value: 4516) Not used (return “1” when read) Not used (do not write “1” to this bit.) Not used (return “1” when read) Not used (return “0” when read) User block 0 E/W enable bit (1, 2) 0 : E/W disabled (800016-FFFF16) 1 : E/W enabled (800016-FFFF16) Not used (return “0” when read) Not used (return “1” when read) Not used (return “0” when read) Notes 1: For this bit to be set to “1”, the user needs to write a “0” and then a “1” to it in succession. For this bit to be set to “0”, write “0” only to this bit. 2: Effective only when the CPU rewrite mode select bit = “1”. Fig 73. Structure of flash memory control register 2 Table 17 State of E/W inhibition function User block 0 E/W enable bit 0 0 1 1 User block 1 E/W enable bit 0 1 0 1 User block 0 Addresses 800016 to FFFF16 E/W disabled E/W disabled E/W enabled E/W enabled User block 1 Addresses 180016 to 7FFF16 E/W disabled E/W enabled E/W disabled E/W enabled Data block Addresses 100016 to 17FF16 E/W enabled E/W enabled E/W enabled E/W enabled Figure 74 shows a flowchart for setting/releasing CPU rewrite mode. Start Single-chip mode or Boot mode Set CPU mode register(1) Transfer CPU rewrite mode control program to internal RAM Jump to control program transferred to internal RAM (Subsequent operations are executed by control program in this RAM) Set CPU rewrite mode select bit to “1” (by writing “0” and then “1” in succession) Set user block 0 E/W enable bit to “1” (by writing “0” and then “1” in succession) Set user block 1 E/W enable bit (At E/W disabled; writing “0” , at E/W enabled; writing “0” and then “1” in succession Using software command executes erase, program, or other operation Execute read array command(2) Set user block 0 E/W enable bit to “0” Set user block 1 E/W enable bit to “0” Write “0” to CPU rewrite mode select bit End Notes 1: Set the main clock as follows depending on the clock division ratio selection bits of CPU mode register (bits 6, 7 of address 003B16). 2: Before exiting the CPU rewrite mode after completing erase or program operation, always be sure to execute the read array command. Fig 74. CPU rewrite mode set/release flowchart be sure to execute Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 77 of 134 38D5 Group <Notes on CPU Rewrite Mode> Take the notes described below when rewriting the flash memory in CPU rewrite mode. (1) Operation speed During CPU rewrite mode, set the system clock φ to 4.0 MHz or less using the main clock division ratio selection bits (bits 6 and 7 of address 003B16). (2) Instructions inhibited against use The instructions which refer to the internal data of the flash memory cannot be used during CPU rewrite mode. (3) Interrupts The interrupts cannot be used during CPU rewrite mode because they refer to the internal data of the flash memory. (4) Watchdog timer If the watchdog timer has been already activated, internal reset due to an underflow will not occur because the watchdog timer is surely cleared during program or erase. (5) Reset Reset is always valid. The MCU is activated using the boot mode at release of reset in the condition of CNVSS = “H”, so that the program will begin at the address which is stored in addresses FFFC16 and FFFD16 of the boot ROM area. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 78 of 134 38D5 Group Software Commands Table 18 lists the software commands. After setting the CPU rewrite mode select bit to “1”, execute a software command to specify an erase or program operation. Each software command is explained below. The RY/BY status flag is set to “0” during program operation and “1” when the program operation is completed as is the status register bit 7 (SR7). At program end, program results can be checked by reading the status register. • Read Array Command (FF16) The read array mode is entered by writing the command code “FF16” in the first bus cycle. When an address to be read is input in one of the bus cycles that follow, the contents of the specified address are read out at the data bus (D0 to D7). The read array mode is retained until another command is written. • Read Status Register Command (7016) When the command code “7016” is written in the first bus cycle, the contents of the status register are read out at the data bus (D0 to D7) by a read in the second bus cycle. The status register is explained in the next section. Start Write “4016” Write Write address Write data Read status register • Clear Status Register Command (5016) This command is used to clear the bits SR4 and SR5 of the status register after they have been set. These bits indicate that operation has ended in an error. To use this command, write the command code “5016” in the first bus cycle. SR7 = “1”? or RY/BY = “1”? NO YES • Program Command (4016) Program operation starts when the command code “40 16 ” is written in the first bus cycle. Then, if the address and data to program are written in the 2nd bus cycle, program operation (data programming and verification) will start. Whether the write operation is completed can be confirmed by read status register or the RY/BY status flag. To read the status register, write the read status register command “70 16 ”. The status register bit 7 (SR7) is set to “0” at the same time the program starts and returned to “1” upon completion of the program. The read status mode remains active until the read array command (“FF16”) is written. NO Program error SR4 = “0”? YES Program completed Fig 75. Program flowchart Table 18 List of software commands (CPU rewrite mode) Command First bus cycle Second bus cycle cycle number Mode Address Data (D0 to D7) FF16 Read array 1 Write X(4) Read status register 2 Write X 7016 Clear status register 1 Write X 5016 Program 2 Write X 4016 Block erase 2 Write X 2016 NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. SRD = Status Register Data WA = Write Address, WD = Write Data BA = Block Address to be erased (Input the maximum address of each block.) X denotes a given address in the User ROM area. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 79 of 134 Mode Address Data (D0 to D7) Read X SRD(1) Write WA(2) WD(2) Write BA(3) D016 38D5 Group • Block Erase Command (2016/D016) By writing the command code “2016” in the first bus cycle and the confirmation command code “D016” and the block address in the second bus cycle that follows, the block erase (erase and erase verify) operation starts for the block address of the flash memory to be specified. Whether the block erase operation is completed can be confirmed by read status register or the RY/BY status flag of flash memory control register. To read the status register, write the status register command “7016”. The status register bit 7 (SR7) is set to “0” at the same time the block erase operation starts and returned to “1” upon completion of the block erase operation. The read status mode at this time remains active until the read array command (“FF16”) is written. The RY/BY status flag register is set to “0” during block erase operation and “1” when the block erase operation is completed as is the status register bit 7 (SR7). After the block erase ends, erase results can be checked by reading the status register. For details, refer to the section where the status register is detailed. Start Write “2016” Write “D016” Block address Read status register SR7 = “1”? or RY/BY = “1”? NO YES SR5 = “0”? YES Erase completed (write read command “FF16”) Fig 76. Erase flowchart Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 80 of 134 NO Erase error 38D5 Group • Status Register The status register shows the operating status of the flash memory and whether erase operations and programs ended successfully or in error. It can be read in the following ways: (1) By reading an arbitrary address from the User ROM area after writing the read status register command (7016) (2) By reading an arbitrary address from the User ROM area in the period from when the program starts or erase operation starts to when the read array command (FF16) is input. Also, the status register can be cleared by writing the clear status register command (5016). After reset, the status register is set to “8016”. Table 19 shows the status register. Each bit in this register is explained below. • Sequencer status (SR7) The sequencer status indicates the operating status of the flash memory. This bit is set to “0” (busy) during write or erase operation and is set to “1” when these operations ends. After power-on, the sequencer status is set to “1” (ready). • Erase status (SR5) The erase status indicates the operating status of erase operation. If an erase error occurs, it is set to “1”. When the erase status is cleared, it is reset to “0”. • Program status (SR4) The program status indicates the operating status of write operation. When a write error occurs, it is set to “1”. The program status is reset to “0” when it is cleared. If “1” is written for any of the SR5 and SR4 bits, the read array, program, and block erase commands are not accepted. Before executing these commands, execute the clear status register command (5016) and clear the status register. Also, if any commands are not correct, both SR5 and SR4 are set to “1”. Table 19 Definition of each bit in status register Each bit of SRD bits Status name SR7 (bit7) SR6 (bit6) SR5 (bit5) SR4 (bit4) SR3 (bit3) SR2 (bit2) SR1 (bit1) SR0 (bit0) Sequencer status Reserved Erase status Program status Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 81 of 134 Definition “1” Ready − Terminated in error Terminated in error − − − − “0” Busy − Terminated normally Terminated normally − − − − 38D5 Group Full Status Check By performing full status check, it is possible to know the execution results of erase and program operations. Figure 77 shows a full status check flowchart and the action to be taken when each error occurs. Read status register SR4 = “1” YES Command sequence error and SR5 = “1”? Execute the clear status register command (5016) to clear the status register. Try performing the operation one more time after confirming that the command is entered correctly. NO SR5 = “0”? NO Block erase error Should an erase error occur, the block in error cannot be used. YES SR4 = “0”? NO Program error Should a program error occur, the block in error cannot be used. YES End (block erase, program) Note: When one of SR5 and SR4 is set to “1”, none of the read array, program, and block erase commands is accepted. Execute the clear status register command (5016) before executing these commands. Fig 77. Full status check flowchart and remedial procedure for errors Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 82 of 134 38D5 Group Functions To Inhibit Rewriting Flash Memory Version To prevent the contents of internal flash memory from being read out or rewritten easily, this MCU incorporates a ROM code protect function for use in parallel I/O mode and an ID code check function for use in standard serial I/O mode. • ROM Code Protect Function The ROM code protect function is the function to inhibit reading out or modifying the contents of internal flash memory by using the ROM code protect control address (address FFDB 16 ) in parallel I/O mode. Figure 78 shows the ROM code protect control address (address FFDB16). (This address exists in the User ROM area.) If one or both of the pair of ROM code protect bits is set to “0”, the ROM code protect is turned on, so that the contents of internal flash memory are protected against readout and modification. The ROM code protect is implemented in two levels. If level 2 is selected, the flash memory is protected even against readout by a shipment inspection LSI tester, etc. When an attempt is made to select both level 1 and level 2, level 2 is selected by default. If both of the two ROM code protect reset bits are set to “00”, the ROM code protect is turned off, so that the contents of internal flash memory can be readout or modified. Once the ROM code protect is turned on, the contents of the ROM code protect reset bits cannot be modified in parallel I/O mode. Use standard serial I/O mode or other modes to rewrite the contents of the ROM code protect disable bits. Rewriting of only the ROM code protect control address (address FFDB16) cannot be performed. When rewriting the ROM code protect reset bit, rewrite the whole user ROM area (block 0) containing the ROM code protect control address. b0 b7 1 1 ROM code protect control address (address FFDB16) ROMCP (FF16 when shipped) Reserved bits (“1” at read/write) ROM code protect level 2 set bits (ROMCP2)(1, 2) b3b2 0 0: Protect enabled 0 1: Protect enabled 1 0: Protect enabled 1 1: Protect disabled ROM code protect reset bits (ROMCR)(3) b5b4 0 0: Protect removed 0 1: Protect set bits effective 1 0: Protect set bits effective 1 1: Protect set bits effective ROM code protect level 1 set bits (ROMCP1)(1) b7b6 0 0: Protect enabled 0 1: Protect enabled 1 0: Protect enabled 1 1: Protect disabled Notes 1: When ROM code protect is turned on, the internal flash memory is protected against readout or modification in parallel I/O mode. 2: When ROM code protect level 2 is turned on, ROM code readout by a shipment inspection LSI tester, etc. also is inhibited. 3: The ROM code protect reset bits can be used to turn off ROM code protect level 1 and ROM code protect level 2. However, no change can be made in parallel I/O mode. Use serial I/O mode or other modes to change settings. Fig 78. Structure of ROM code protect control address Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 83 of 134 38D5 Group • ID Code Check Function Use this function in standard serial I/O mode. When the contents of the flash memory are not blank, the ID code sent from the programmer is compared with the ID code written in the flash memory to see if they match. If the ID codes do not match, the commands sent from the programmer are not accepted. The ID code consists of 8-bit data, and its areas are FFD416 to FFDA16. Write a program which has had the ID code preset at these addresses to the flash memory. Address FFD416 ID1 FFD516 ID2 FFD616 ID3 FFD716 ID4 FFD816 ID5 FFD916 ID6 FFDA16 ID7 FFDB16 ROM code protect control Interrupt vector area Fig 79. ID code store addresses Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 84 of 134 38D5 Group Parallel I/O Mode The parallel I/O mode is used to input/output software commands, address and data in parallel for operation (read, program and erase) to internal flash memory. • User ROM and Boot ROM Areas In parallel I/O mode, the User ROM and Boot ROM areas shown in Figure 70 can be rewritten. Both areas of flash memory can be operated on in the same way. The Boot ROM area is 4 Kbytes in size and located at addresses F00016 through FFFF 16 . Make sure program and block erase operations are always performed within this address range. (Access to any location outside this address range is prohibited.) In the Boot ROM area, an erase block operation is applied to only one 4 K byte block. The boot ROM area has had a standard serial I/O mode control program stored in it when shipped from the factory. Therefore, using the MCU in standard serial I/O mode, do not rewrite to the Boot ROM area. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 85 of 134 38D5 Group Standard serial I/O Mode The standard serial I/O mode inputs and outputs the software commands, addresses and data needed to operate (read, program, erase, etc.) the internal flash memory. This I/O is clock synchronized serial. This mode requires a purpose-specific peripheral unit. The standard serial I/O mode is different from the parallel I/O mode in that the CPU controls flash memory rewrite (uses the CPU rewrite mode), rewrite data input and so forth. The standard serial I/O mode is started by connecting “H” to the CNVSS pin and “H” to the P4 1 (BOOTENT) pin, and releasing the reset operation. (In the ordinary microcomputer mode, set CNVSS pin to “L” level.) This control program is written in the Boot ROM area when the product is shipped from Renesas. Accordingly, make note of the fact that the standard serial I/O mode cannot be used if the Boot ROM area is rewritten in parallel I/O mode. The standard serial I/ O mode has standard serial I/O mode 1 of the clock synchronous serial and standard serial I/O mode 2 of the clock asynchronous serial. Tables 20 and 21 show description of pin function (standard serial I/O mode). Figure 80 to 83 show the pin connections for the standard serial I/O mode. In standard serial I/O mode, only the User ROM area shown in Figure 70 can be rewritten. The Boot ROM area cannot be written. In standard serial I/O mode, a 7-byte ID code is used. When there is data in the flash memory, this function determines whether the ID code sent from the peripheral unit (programmer) and those written in the flash memory match. The commands sent from the peripheral unit (programmer) are not accepted unless the ID code matches. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 86 of 134 38D5 Group Table 20 Description of pin function (Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode 1) Pin name VCC,VSS CNVSS RESET XIN XOUT AVSS VREF P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 P40 P41 P42 P43 Signal name Power supply CNVSS Reset input I/O I I I Function Apply 2.7 to 5.5 V to the VCC pin and 0 V to the Vss pin. After input of port is set, input “H” level. Clock input Clock output Analog power supply input Reference voltage input I/O port I O Reset input pin. To reset the microcomputer, RESET pin should be held at an “L” level for 16 cycles or more of XIN. Connect an oscillation circuit between the XIN and XOUT pins. As for the connection method, refer to the “clock generating circuit”. I I/O Connect AVss to VSS. Apply reference voltage of A/D convertor to this pin. Input “L” or “H” level, or keep open. RxD input TxD output SCLK input BUSY output I O I O Serial data input pin. Serial data output pin. Serial clock input pin. BUSY signal output pin. Table 21 Description of pin function (Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode 2) Pin name VCC,VSS CNVSS RESET XIN XOUT AVSS VREF P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 P40 P41 P42 P43 Signal name Power supply CNVSS Reset input I/O I I I Clock input Clock output Analog power supply input Reference voltage input I/O port I O Reset input pin. To reset the microcomputer, RESET pin should be held at an “L” level for 16 cycles or more of XIN. Connect an oscillation circuit between the XIN and XOUT pins. As for the connection method, refer to the “clock generating circuit”. I I/O Connect AVss to VSS. Apply reference voltage of A/D convertor to this pin. Input “L” or “H” level, or keep open. RxD input TxD output SCLK input BUSY output I O I O Serial data input pin. Serial data output pin. Input “L” level. BUSY signal output pin. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 87 of 134 Function Apply 2.7 to 5.5 V to the Vcc pin and 0 V to the VSS pin. After input of port is set, input “H” level. 38D5 Group P2 0 /SEG 0 /(KW 4) P2 1 /SEG 1 /(KW 5) P2 2 /SEG 2 /(KW 6) P2 3 /SEG 3 /(KW 7) P2 4/SEG 4 P2 5/SEG 5 P2 6/SEG 6 P2 7/SEG 7 P0 0/SEG 8 P0 1/SEG 9 P0 2/SEG 10 P0 3/SEG 11 P0 4/SEG 12 P0 5/SEG 13 P0 6/SEG 14 P0 7/SEG 15 P1 0/SEG 16 P1 1/SEG 17 P1 2/SEG 18 P1 3/SEG 19 P1 4/SEG 20 P1 5/SEG 21 P1 6/SEG 22 P1 7/SEG 23 Flash memory version 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 BUSY SCLK TXD RXD P47/SRDY2/(KW3) P46/SCLK2/(KW2) P45/SOUT2/(KW1) P44/SIN2/(KW0) P43/SRDY1 P42/SCLK1 P41/TXD P40/RXD AVss VREF P57/AN7/ADKEY0 P56/AN6 P55/AN5 P54/AN4 P53/AN3 P52/AN2 65 66 67 68 69 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 M38D59FFFP M3822xMX-XXXFP 78 79 80 P30/SEG24 P31/SEG25 P32/SEG26 P33/SEG27 P34/SEG28 P35/SEG29 P36/SEG30 P37/SEG31 COM7/SEG32 COM6/SEG33 COM5/SEG34 COM4/SEG35 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 P5 1 /AN 1 /RTP 1 P5 0 /AN 0 /RTP 0 P6 7/CNTR 1/(LED 5 ) P6 6/INT 10/CNTR 0/(LED 4 ) P6 5/T XOUT1 /(LED 3 ) P6 4/INT 2 /(LED 2 ) P6 3/T XOUT2 /(LED 1 ) P6 2 /INT 00 /(LED 0 ) CNV SS RESET P6 1 /X COUT P6 0 /X CIN V SS X IN ∗ X OUT V CC P7 4/PWM 1 /T 4OUT P7 3/PWM 0 /T 3OUT P7 2 /T 2OUT /CKOUT VL3 VL2 P7 1 /C 2 /INT 11 P7 0 /C 1 /INT 01 VL1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 VPP RESET ∗Connect oscillation circuit. GND indicates flash memory pin. VCC Package type: PRQP0080GB-A (80P6N-A) Fig 80. Connection for standard serial I/O mode 1 Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 88 of 134 38D5 Group 41 42 43 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 44 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 15 16 13 14 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 4 5 P16/SEG22 P17/SEG23 P30/SEG24 P31/SEG25 P32/SEG26 P33/SEG27 P34/SEG28 P35/SEG29 P36/SEG30 P37/SEG31 COM7/SEG32 COM6/SEG33 COM5/SEG34 COM4/SEG35 COM3 COM2 COM1 COM0 VL1 P70/C1/INT01 P6 7 /CNTR 1 /(LED 5 ) P6 6 /INT 10 /CNTR 0 /(LED 4) P6 5 /T XOUT1 /(LED3) P6 4 /INT 2 /(LED 2) P6 3 /T XOUT2 /(LED 1 ) P6 2 /INT 00 /(LED 0 ) CNV SS RESET P6 1 /X COUT P6 0 /X CIN V SS X IN ∗ X OUT V CC P7 4/PWM 1 /T 4OUT P7 3/PWM 0 /T 3OUT P7 2 /T 2OUT /CKOUT V L3 V L2 P7 1 /C 2 /INT 11 1 M38D59FFHP 3 TXD RXD 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 2 BUSY “L”INPUT P21/SEG1/(KW5) P20/SEG0/(KW4) P47/SRDY2/(KW3) P46/SCLK2/(KW2) P45/SOUT2/(KW1) P44/SIN2/(KW0) P43/SRDY1 P42/SCLK1 P41/TXD P40/RXD AVss VREF P57/AN7/ADKEY0 P56/AN6 P55/AN5 P54/AN4 P53/AN3 P52/AN2 P51/AN1/RTP1 P50/AN0/RTP0 59 60 P2 2 /SEG 2 /(KW 6 ) P2 3 /SEG 3 /(KW 7 ) P2 4 /SEG 4 P2 5 /SEG 5 P2 6 /SEG 6 P2 7 /SEG 7 P0 0 /SEG 8 P0 1 /SEG 9 P0 2 /SEG 10 P0 3 /SEG 11 P0 4 /SEG 12 P0 5 /SEG 13 P0 6 /SEG 14 P0 7 /SEG 15 P1 0 /SEG 16 P1 1 /SEG 17 P1 2 /SEG 18 P1 3 /SEG 19 P1 4 /SEG 20 P1 5 /SEG 21 Flash memory version VPP ∗Connect oscillation circuit. RESET indicates flash memory pin. GND Vcc Package type: PLQP0080KB-A (80P6Q-A) Fig 81. Connection for standard serial I/O mode 2 Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 89 of 134 38D5 Group Flash memory version 38D5 Group T_VDD Vcc T_VPP N.C. 4.7 kΩ T_RXD P41 (TxD) T_TXD P40 (RxD) T_SCLK P42 (SCLK) CNVSS T_PGM/OE/MD 4.7 kΩ T_BUSY P43 (BUSY) RESET circuit RESET T_RESET GND Vss AVss XIN XOUT Set the same termination as the single-chip mode. Note 1: For the programmer circuit, the wiring capacity of each signal pin must not exceed 47pF. Fig 82. When using programmer (in standard serial I/O mode 1) of Suisei Electronics System Co., LTD, connection example Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 90 of 134 38D5 Group Flash memory version 38D5 Group Vcc Vcc CNVSS 4.7 kΩ 4.7 kΩ 4.7 kΩ P41 (TxD) P40 (RxD) P42 (SCLK) P43 (BUSY) 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 RESET circuit ∗1 RESET Vss AVss XIN XOUT Set the same termination as the single-chip mode. ∗ 1: Open-collector buffer Note 1: For the programmer circuit, the wiring capacity of each signal pin must not exceed 47pF. Fig 83. When using E8 programmer (in standard serial I/O mode 1) connection example Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 91 of 134 38D5 Group Flash memory version td(CNVSS-RESET) td(P41-RESET) Power source RESET CNVSS P41(TXD) P42(SCLK) P43(BUSY) P40(RXD) Symbol Limits Min. Typ. Max. td(CNVSS-RESET) 0 - - td(P41-RESET) 0 Unit ms Note: In the standard serial I/O mode 1, input “H” to the P42 pin. Be sure to set the CNVss pin to “H” before rising RESET. Be sure to set the P41 pin to “H” before rising RESET. ms Fig 84. Operating waveform for standard serial I/O mode 1 Flash memory version td(CNVSS-RESET) td(P41-RESET) Power source RESET CNVSS P41(TXD) P42(SCLK) P43(BUSY) P40(RXD) Symbol Limits Min. Typ. Max. td(CNVSS-RESET) 0 - - td(P41-RESET) 0 Unit ms Note: In the standard serial I/O mode 2, input “H” to the P42 pin. Be sure to set the CNVss pin to “H” before rising RESET. Be sure to set the P41 pin to “H” before rising RESET. ms Fig 85. Operating waveform for standard serial I/O mode 2 Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 92 of 134 38D5 Group NOTES ON USE Processor Status Register The contents of the processor status register (PS) after a reset are undefined, except for the interrupt disable flag (I) which is “1”. After a reset, initialize flags which affect program execution. In particular, it is essential to initialize the index X mode (T) and the decimal mode (D) flags because of their effect on calculations. Initialize these flags at beginning of the program. Interrupt The contents of the interrupt request bits do not change immediately after they have been written. After writing to an interrupt request register, execute at least one instruction before performing a BBC or BBS instruction. Decimal Calculations • To calculate in decimal notation, set the decimal mode flag (D) to “1”, then execute an ADC or SBC instruction. After executing an ADC or SBC instruction, execute at least one instruction before executing a SEC, CLC, or CLD instruction. • In decimal mode, the values of the negative (N), overflow (V), and zero (Z) flags are invalid. Timers The division ratio is 1/(n+1) when the value n (0 to 255) is written to the timer latch. Multiplication and Division Instructions The index mode (T) and the decimal mode (D) flags do not affect the MUL and DIV instruction. The execution of these instructions does not change the contents of the processor status register. Direction Registers The values of the port direction registers cannot be read. This means, it is impossible to use the LDA instruction, memory operation instruction when the T flag is “1”, addressing mode using direction register values as qualifiers, and bit test instructions such as BBC and BBS. It is also impossible to use bit operation instructions such as CLB and SEB, and read-modifywrite instructions to direction registers, including calculations such as ROR. To set the direction registers, use instructions such as LDM or STA. Serial Interface In clock synchronous serial I/O, if the receive side is using an external clock and it is to output the SRDY signal, set the transmit enable bit, the receive enable bit, and the SRDY output enable bit to “1”. Serial I/O continues to output the final bit from the TXD pin after transmission is completed. A/D Converter The comparator is constructed linked to a capacitor. The conversion accuracy may be low because the charge is lost if the conversion speed is not enough. Accordingly, set f(XIN) to at least 500kHz during A/D conversion in the XIN mode. Also, do not execute the STP or WIT instruction during an A/D conversion. In the low-speed mode, since the A/D conversion is executed by the on-chip oscillator, the minimum value of f(XIN) frequency is not limited. LCD Drive Control Circuit Execution of the STP instruction sets the LCD enable bit (bit 4 of the LCD mode register) to “0” and the LCD panel turns off. To make the LCD panel turn on after returning from the stop mode, set the LCD enable bit to “1”. Instruction Execution Time The instruction execution time is obtained by multiplying the frequency of the internal clock φ by the number of cycles needed to execute an instruction. The number of cycles required to execute an instruction is shown in the list of machine instructions. Power Source Voltage When the power source voltage value of a microcomputer is less than the value which is indicated as the recommended operating conditions, the microcomputer does not operate normally and may perform unstable operation. In a system where the power source voltage drops slowly when the power source voltage drops or the power supply is turned off, reset a microcomputer when the power source voltage is less than the recommended operating conditions and design a system not to cause errors to the system by this unstable operation. Handling of Power Source Pin In order to avoid a latch-up occurrence, connect a capacitor suitable for high frequencies as bypass capacitor between power source pin (VCC pin) and GND pin (Vss pin), and between power source pin (V CC pin) and analog power source pin (AV CC ). Besides, connect the capacitor to as close as possible. For bypass capacitor which should not be located too far from the pins to be connected, a ceramic capacitor of 0.1 µF is recommended. LCD drive power supply Power supply capacitor may be insufficient with the division resistance for LCD power supply, and the characteristic of the LCD panel. In this case, there is the method of connecting the bypass capacitor about 0.1 − 0.33 µ F to V L1 − V L3 pins. The example of a strengthening measure of the LCD drive power supply is shown below. VL3 VL2 • Connect by the shortest possible wiring. • Connect the bypass capacitor to the VL1 −VL3 pins as short as possible. (Referential value:0.1−0.33 µF) VL1 Fig. 86 Strengthening measure example of LCD drive power supply Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 93 of 134 38D5 Group NOTES ON QzROM VERSION Wiring to OSCSEL pin 1. OSCSEL = L Connect the OSCSEL pin the shortest possible to the GND pattern which is supplied to the VSS pin of the microcomputer. In addition connecting an approximately 5 kΩ resistor in series to the GND could improve noise immunity. In this case as well as the above mention, connect the pin the shortest possible to the GND pattern which is supplied to the V SS pin of the microcomputer. 2. OSCSEL = H Connect the OSCSEL pin the shortest possible to the V CC pattern which is supplied to the VCC pin of the microcomputer. In addition connecting an approximately 5 kΩ resistor in series to the VCC could improve noise immunity. In this case as well as the above mention, connect the pin the shortest possible to the V CC pattern which is supplied to the V CC pin of the microcomputer. • Reason The OSCSEL pin is the power source input pin for the built-in QzROM. When programming in the QzROM, the impedance of the OSCSEL pin is low to allow the electric current for writing to flow into the built-in QzROM. Because of this, noise can enter easily. If noise enters the OSCSEL pin, abnormal instruction codes or data are read from the QzROM, which may cause a program runaway. Termination of OSCSEL pin (2) OSCSEL = H (1) OSCSEL = L (1) (1) The shortest The shortest VCC OSCSEL about 5 kΩ about 5 kΩ OSCSEL VSS (1) The shortest (1) Product shipped in blank As for the product shipped in blank, Renesas does not perform the writing test to user ROM area after the assembly process though the QzROM writing test is performed enough before the assembly process. Therefore, a writing error of approximate 0.1% may occur. Moreover, please note the contact of cables and foreign bodies on a socket, etc. because a writing environment may cause some writing errors. Notes On QzROM Writing Orders When ordering the QzROM product shipped after writing, submit the mask file (extension: .msk) which is made by the mask file converter MM. • Be sure to set the ROM option data* setup when making the mask file by using the mask file converter MM.. The ROM code protect is specified according to the ROM option data* in the mask file which is submitted at ordering. Note that the mask file which has nothing at the ROM option data* or has the data other than “00 16 ”, “FE 16 ” and “FF 16 ” can not be accepted. • Set “FF16” to the ROM code protect address in ROM data regardless of the presence or absence of a protect. When data other than “FF16” is set, we may ask that the ROM data be submitted again. * ROM option data: mask option noted in MM Data Required For QzROM Writing Orders The following are necessary when ordering a QzROM product shipped after writing: 1. QzROM Writing Confirmation Form* 2. Mark Specification Form* 3. ROM data...........Mask file * For the QzROM writing confirmation form and the mark specification form, refer to the “Renesas Technology Corp.” Homepage (http://www.renesas.com/homepage.jsp). Note that we cannot deal with special font marking (customer's trademark etc.) in QzROM microcomputer. The shortest QzROM Receive Flow When writing to QzROM is performed by user side, the receiving inspection by the following flow is necessary. Note 1: It shows the microcomputer’s pin Fig. 87 Wiring for the OSCSEL pin Precautions Regarding Overvoltage in QzROM Version Make sure that voltage exceeding the VCC pin voltage is not applied to other pins. In particular, ensure that the state indicated by bold lines in figure below does not occur for OSCSEL pin (VPP power source pin for QzROM) during power-on or poweroff. Otherwise the contents of QzROM could be rewritten. QzROM product shipped after writing Renesas Renesas Programming Shipping Verify test Shipping ∼ ∼ 1.8V (1) QzROM product shipped in blank “protect disabled” “protect enabled to the protect area 1” User Receiving inspection (Blank check) User (2) 1.8V Receiving inspection of unprotected area (Verify test) Programming Programming to unprotected area Verify test for all area VCC pin voltage ∼ ∼ OSCSEL pin voltage “H” input ∼ ∼ OSCSEL pin voltage “L” input (1) Input voltage to other MCU pins rises before VCC pin voltage. (2) Input voltage to other MCU pins falls after VCC pin voltage. Note: The internal circuitry is unstable when VCC is below the minimum voltage specification of 1.8 V (shaded portion), so particular care should be exercised regarding overvoltage. Fig. 88 Example of Overvoltage Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 94 of 134 Verify test for unprotected area Fig. 89 QzROM receive flow 38D5 Group NOTES ON FLASH MEMORY VERSION CPU Rewrite Mode (1) Operation speed During CPU rewrite mode, set the system clock φ 4.0 MHz or less using the main clock division ratio selection bits (bits 6 and 7 of address 003B16). (2) Instructions inhibited against use The instructions which refer to the internal data of the flash memory cannot be used during the CPU rewrite mode. (3) Interrupts inhibited against use The interrupts cannot be used during the CPU rewrite mode because they refer to the internal data of the flash memory. (4) Watchdog timer In case of the watchdog timer has been running already, the internal reset generated by watchdog timer underflow does not happen, because of watchdog timer is always clearing during program or erase operation. (5) Reset Reset is always valid. In case of CNVSS = “H” when reset is released, boot mode is active. So the program starts from the address contained in address FFFC16 and FFFD16 in boot ROM area. CNVSS Pin The CNVSS pin determines the flash memory mode. Connect the CNVSS /VPP pin the shortest possible to the GND pattern which is supplied to the VSS pin of the microcomputer. In addition connecting an approximately 5 kΩ. resistor in series to the GND could improve noise immunity. In this case as well as the above mention, connect the pin the shortest possible to the GND pattern which is supplied to the V S S pin of the microcomputer. Note. When the boot mode or the standard serial I/O mode is used, a switch of the input level to the CNVSS pin is required. The shortest (1) CNVSS Approx. 5kΩ VSS (1) The shortest Note 1: Shows the microcomputer’s pin. Fig 90. Wiring for the CNVSS Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 95 of 134 NOTES ON DIFFERENCES BETWEEN QzROM VERSION AND FLASH MEMORY VERSION The QzROM and flash memory versions differ in their manufacturing processes, built-in ROM, and layout patterns. Because of these differences, characteristic values, operation margins, noise immunity, and noise radiation and oscillation circuit constants may vary within the specified range of electrical characteristics. When switching to the QzROM version, implement system evaluations equivalent to those performed in the flash memory version. Confirm page 11 about the differences of functions. 38D5 Group Countermeasures against noise Noise (1) Shortest wiring length 1. Wiring for RESET pin Make the length of wiring which is connected to the RESET pin as short as possible. Especially, connect a capacitor across the RESET pin and the V SS pin with the shortest possible wiring (within 20 mm). • Reason The width of a pulse input into the RESET pin is determined by the timing necessary conditions. If noise having a shorter pulse width than the standard is input to the RESET pin, the reset is released before the internal state of the microcomputer is completely initialized. This may cause a program runaway. XIN XOUT VSS N.G. XIN XOUT VSS O.K. Fig. 92 Wiring for clock I/O pins Noise Reset circuit RESET VSS VSS N.G. Reset circuit VSS (2) Connection of bypass capacitor across VSS line and VCC line In order to stabilize the system operation and avoid the latch-up, connect an approximately 0.1 µF bypass capacitor across the VSS line and the VCC line as follows: • Connect a bypass capacitor across the VSS pin and the VCC pin at equal length. • Connect a bypass capacitor across the VSS pin and the VCC pin with the shortest possible wiring. • Use lines with a larger diameter than other signal lines for VSS line and VCC line. • Connect the power source wiring via a bypass capacitor to the VSS pin and the VCC pin. RESET VSS VCC VCC VSS VSS O.K. Fig. 91 Wiring for the RESET pin 2. Wiring for clock input/output pins • Make the length of wiring which is connected to clock I/O pins as short as possible. • Make the length of wiring (within 20 mm) across the grounding lead of a capacitor which is connected to an oscillator and the VSS pin of a microcomputer as short as possible. • Separate the VSS pattern only for oscillation from other VSS patterns. • Reason If noise enters clock I/O pins, clock waveforms may be deformed. This may cause a program failure or program runaway. Also, if a potential difference is caused by the noise between the VSS level of a microcomputer and the VSS level of an oscillator, the correct clock will not be input in the microcomputer. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 96 of 134 N.G. O.K. Fig. 93 Bypass capacitor across the VSS line and the VCC line 38D5 Group (3) Oscillator concerns In order to obtain the stabilized operation clock on the user system and its condition, contact the oscillator manufacturer and select the oscillator and oscillation circuit constants. Be careful especially when range of voltage and temperature is wide. Also, take care to prevent an oscillator that generates clocks for a microcomputer operation from being affected by other signals. 1. Keeping oscillator away from large current signal lines Install a microcomputer (and especially an oscillator) as far as possible from signal lines where a current larger than the tolerance of current value flows. • Reason In the system using a microcomputer, there are signal lines for controlling motors, LEDs, and thermal heads or others. When a large current flows through those signal lines, strong noise occurs because of mutual inductance. 2. Installing oscillator away from signal lines where potential levels change frequently Install an oscillator and a connecting pattern of an oscillator away from signal lines where potential levels change frequently. Also, do not cross such signal lines over the clock lines or the signal lines which are sensitive to noise. • Reason Signal lines where potential levels change frequently (such as the CNTR pin signal line) may affect other lines at signal rising edge or falling edge. If such lines cross over a clock line, clock waveforms may be deformed, which causes a microcomputer failure or a program runaway. 1. Keeping oscillator away from large current signal lines Microcomputer Mutual inductance M XIN XOUT VSS Large current GND 2. Installing oscillator away from signal lines where potential levels change frequently Do not cross. CNTR XIN XOUT VSS N.G. Fig. 94 Wiring for a large current signal line/Wiring of signal lines where potential levels change frequently Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 97 of 134 (4) Analog input The analog input pin is connected to the capacitor of a voltage comparator. Accordingly, sufficient accuracy may not be obtained by the charge/discharge current at the time of A/D conversion when the analog signal source of high-impedance is connected to an analog input pin. In order to obtain the A/D conversion result stabilized more, please lower the impedance of an analog signal source, or add the smoothing capacitor to an analog input pin. (5) Difference of memory size When memory size differ in one group, actual values such as an electrical characteristics, A/D conversion accuracy, and the amount of proof of noise incorrect operation may differ from the ideal values. When these products are used switching, perform system evaluation for each product of every after confirming product specification. 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION QzROM VERSION ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS Absolute Maximum Ratings Table 22 Absolute maximum ratings Symbol VCC VI VI VI VI VI VI VI VO VO VO VO VO VO Pd Topr Tstg Parameter Power source voltage Input voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P70−P74 Input voltage VL1 Input voltage VL2 Input voltage VL3 Input voltage C1, C2 Input voltage Input voltage Output voltage Output voltage Conditions All voltages are based on VSS. When an input voltage is measured, output transistors are cut off. RESET, XIN OSCSEL C1, C2 P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 At output port At segment output Output voltage P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 Output voltage VL3 All voltages are Output voltage VL2, SEG32−SEG35, COM0−COM3 based on VSS. Output voltage XOUT Power dissipation Ta = 25°C Operating temperature Storage temperature Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 98 of 134 Ratings −0.3 to 6.5 −0.3 to VCC+0.3 Unit V V −0.3 to VL2 VL1 to VL3 VL2 to 6.5 −0.3 to 6.5 −0.3 to VCC+0.3 V V V V V −0.3 to 8.0 −0.3 to 6.5 −0.3 to VCC+0.3 −0.3 to VL3+0.3 −0.3 to VCC+0.3 −0.3 to 6.5 −0.3 to VL3+0.3 −0.3 to VCC+0.3 300 −20 to 85 −40 to 125 V V V V V V V V mW °C °C 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION Recommended Operating Conditions Table 23 Recommended operating conditions (1) (VCC = 1.8 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C unless otherwise noted) Symbol VCC Limits Parameter Power source voltage (1) Frequency/2 mode (2) Frequency/4 mode Min. Typ. Max. Unit f(XIN) ≤ 12.5MHz 4.5 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8MHz 4.0 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4MHz 2.0 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 2MHz 1.8 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 16MHz 4.5 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8MHz 2.0 5.5 V V f(XIN) ≤ 4MHz 1.8 5.5 f(XIN) ≤ 16MHz 4.5 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8MHz 2.0 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4MHz 1.8 5.5 V 1.8 5.5 V On-chip oscillator mode 1.8 5.5 V When start oscillating (3) 0.05 × f + 1.9 Frequency/8 mode Low-speed mode VSS Power source voltage VLI VL1 input voltage V 0 Voltage multiplier is used 1.3 V 1.8 2.0 2.1 V VCC V VCC V VREF A/D converter reference voltage AVSS Analog power source voltage VIA Analog input voltage AN0−AN7 VIH “H” input voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P24−P27, P30−P37, P41, P43, P50−P57, P60(CM4=0), P61, P65, P72−P74 0.7VCC VCC V VIH “H” input voltage P20−P23, P40, P42, P44−47, P62−P64, P66, P67, P70, P71 0.8VCC VCC V VIH “H” input voltage RESET 2.2V < VCC ≤ 5.5V 0.8VCC VCC V VCC ≤ 2.2V 65 × VCC - 99 VCC V 0 V AVSS VCC - 100 VIH “H” input voltage XIN VCC V VIL “L” input voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P24−P27, P30−P37, P41, P43, P50−P57, P60, P61, P65, P72−P74 0.8VCC 0 0.3VCC V VIL “L” input voltage P20−P23, P40, P42, P44−P47, P62−P64, P66, P67, P70, P71, OSCSEL 0 0.2VCC V VIL “L” input voltage RESET 2.2V < VCC ≤ 5.5V 0 0.2VCC V VCC ≤ 2.2V 0 65 × VCC − 99 V 100 VIL 0 “L” input voltage XIN 0.2VCC V NOTES: 1. When the A/D converter is used, refer to the recommended operating conditions of the A/D converter. 2. 12.5 MHz < f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz is not available in the frequency/2 mode. 3. The oscillation start voltage and the oscillation start time differ depending on factors such as the oscillator, circuit constants, and operating temperature range. Note that oscillation start may be particularly difficult at low voltage when using a high-frequency oscillator. f: Oscillation frequency (1 MHz ≤ f(XIN) ≤ 8 MHz) of oscillator. When the 8 MHz oscillation is used, assign “8” to “f”. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 99 of 134 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION Table 24 Recommended operating conditions (2) (VCC = 1.8 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Parameter Min. Limits Typ. Max. −40 Unit ΣIOH(peak) “H” total peak output current (1) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P72−P74 ΣIOH(peak) “H” total peak output current (1) P40−47, P50−P57, P60−P67 −40 mA ΣIOL(peak) “L” total peak output current (1) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P72−P74 40 mA ΣIOL(peak) “L” total peak output current (1) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60, P61 40 mA ΣIOL(peak) “L” total peak output current (1) P62−P67 110 mA ΣIOH(avg) “H” total average output current (1) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P72−P74 −20 mA ΣIOH(avg) “H” total average output current (1) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67 −20 mA ΣIOL(avg) “L” total average output current (1) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P72−P74 20 mA ΣIOL(avg) “L” total average output current (1) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60, P61 20 mA ΣIOL(avg) “L” total average output current (1) P62−P67 90 mA IOH(peak) “H” peak output current (2) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 −2 mA IOH(peak) “H” peak output current (2) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 −5 mA IOL(peak) “L” peak output current (2) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 5 mA IOL(peak) “L” peak output current (2) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60, P61, P72−P74 10 mA IOL(peak) “L” peak output current (2) P62−P67 30 mA IOH(avg) “H” average output current (3) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 −1.0 mA IOH(avg) “H” average output current (3) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 −2.5 mA IOL(avg) “L” average output current (3) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 2.5 mA IOL(avg) “L” average output current (3) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60, P61, P72−P74 5.0 mA IOL(avg) “L” average output current (3) P62−P67 15 mA mA NOTES: 1. The total output current is the sum of all the currents flowing through all the applicable ports. The total average current is an average value measured over 100 ms. The total peak current is the peak value of all the currents. 2. The peak output current is the peak current flowing in each port. 3. The average output current is average value measured over 100 ms. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 100 of 134 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION Table 25 Recommended operating conditions (3) (VCC = 1.8 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol f(CNTR0) f(CNTR1) Parameter Conditions Timer X and Timer Y Input frequency (duty cycle 50%) Limits Min. Typ. 4.5 ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V 6.25 MHz 4.0 ≤ VCC < 4.5V 2 × Vcc −4 MHz 2.0 ≤ VCC < 4.0V Vcc MHz 5 × Vcc −8 MHz 4.5 ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V 16 MHz 4.0 ≤ VCC < 4.5V 4 × Vcc −8 MHz 2.0 ≤ VCC < 4.0V 2 × Vcc MHz VCC < 2.0V f(Tclk) Timer X, Timer Y, Timer 1, Timer 2, Timer 3, Timer 4 clock input frequency (Count source frequency of each timer) f(φ) VCC < 2.0V 10 × Vcc −16 MHz 6.25 MHz 4.0 ≤ VCC < 4.5V 4 MHz 2.0 ≤ VCC < 4.0V Vcc MHz 5 × Vcc −8 MHz 4.5 ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V System clock φ frequency (1) VCC < 2.0V f(XIN) Main clock input frequency (duty cycle 50%) (2)(3) f(XCIN) Unit Max. 4.5 ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V 1.0 16 MHz 2.0 ≤ VCC < 4.5V 1.0 8.0 MHz VCC < 2.0V 1.0 20 × Vcc −32 MHz 80 kHz Sub-clock oscillation frequency (duty cycle 50%)(4)(5) 32.768 NOTES: Relationship between system clock φ frequency and power source voltage is shown in the graph below. When the A/D converter is used, refer to the recommended operating conditions of the A/D converter. 12.5 MHz < f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz is not available in the frequency/2 mode. The oscillation start voltage and the oscillation start time differ depending on factors such as the oscillator, circuit constants, and operating temperature range. Note that oscillation start may be particularly difficult at low voltage when using a high-frequency oscillator. 5. When using the microcomputer in low-speed mode, set the clock input oscillation frequency on condition that f(XCIN) < f(XIN)/3. 1. 2. 3. 4. <System clock φ frequency> <Main clock XIN frequency> [MHz] 16 Main clock X IN frequency System clock φ frequency [MHz] 6.25 4.0 2.0 8.0 4.0 1.0 1.0 0 1.8 2.0 4.0 4.5 5.5 [V] Power source voltage Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 101 of 134 0 1.8 2.0 4.5 Power source voltage 5.5 [V] 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION Electrical Characteristics Table 26 Electrical characteristics (1) (VCC = 1.8 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol VOH VOH VOL VOL VOL Parameter “H” output voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 Test conditions Limits Min. IOH= −2.5mA VCC−2.0 IOH= −0.6mA VCC=2.5V VCC−1.0 Typ. Max. V “H” output voltage P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 (1) IOH= −5mA VCC−2.0 IOH= −1.25mA VCC−0.5 IOH= −1.25mA VCC=2.5V VCC−1.0 “L” output voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 IOL=5mA 2.0 IOL=1.25mA 0.5 IOL=1.25mA VCC=2.5V 1.0 “L” output voltage P40−P47, P50−P57, P60, P61 P72−P74 (1) IOL=10mA 2.0 IOL=2.5mA 0.5 IOL=2.5mA VCC=2.5V 1.0 IOL=15mA 2.0 IOL=3.0mA VCC=2.5V 0.8 “L” output voltage P62−P67 Unit V V V V VT+ − VT- Hysteresis INT00, INT01, INT10, INT11, INT2, CNTR0, CNTR1, KW0−KW7 0.5 V VT+ − VT- Hysteresis SIN2, SCLK1, SCLK2, RXD 0.5 V VT+ − VT- Hysteresis RESET VCC = 2.0 V to 5.5 V on RESET 0.5 V IIH “H” input current P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 VI=VCC 5.0 µA IIH “H” input current P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P70−P74 VI=VCC 5.0 µA IIH “H” input current RESET, OSCSEL VI=VCC 5.0 µA IIH “H” input current XIN VI=VCC IIL “L” input current P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 VCC=5V, VI=VSS Pull-up “ON” “L” input current P40−P47, P50−P57 P60−P67, P72−P74 VCC=5V, VI=VSS Pull-up “ON” IIL VI=VSS Pull-up “OFF” VCC=3V, VI=VSS Pull-up “ON” −60 −25 −120 −50 −30 −6.5 −70 −25 VI=VSS Pull-up “OFF” VCC=3V, VI=VSS Pull-up “ON” IIL “L” input current RESET, OSCSEL VI=VSS IIL “L” input current XIN VI=VSS f(OCO) On-chip oscillator frequency VCC=5V, Ta =25°C µA 4.0 −5.0 −240 −100 −5.0 −140 −45 −5.0 −4.0 2500 5000 µA µA µA µA µA µA µA µA 7500 kHz NOTE: 1. When the port Xc switch bit (bit 4 of address 003B16) of CPU mode register is “1”, the drivability of P61 is different from the above. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 102 of 134 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION Table 27 Electrical characteristics (2) (Vcc = 1.8 to 5.5 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz, output transistors in the cut-off state, A/D converter stopped, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Parameter Limits Test conditions VRAM RAM hold voltage When clock is stopped ICC Power source current Frequency/2 mode VCC=5V VCC=2.5V Frequency/8 mode VCC=5.0V VCC=2.5V Low-speed mode VCC=5.0V VCC=2.5V On-chip oscillator mode f(XIN), f(XCIN) = stop All oscillations stopped (in STP state) Current increased at A/D converter operating Typ. Max. 1.8 VCC=5V VCC=2.5V Frequency/4 mode Min. Unit 5.5 V f(XIN)=12.5MHz 6.4 13 mA f(XIN)=12.5MHz (in WIT state) 1.5 3.0 mA mA f(XIN)=4MHz 2.2 3.0 f(XIN)=4MHz 0.6 1.2 mA f(XIN)=4MHz (in WIT state) 0.3 0.6 mA f(XIN)=2MHz 0.4 0.8 mA f(XIN)=12.5MHz 3.5 10 mA f(XIN)=12.5MHz (in WIT state) 1.5 3 mA mA f(XIN)=4MHz 1.5 2.5 f(XIN)=8MHz 0.8 2.5 mA f(XIN)=8MHz (in WIT state) 0.3 0.6 mA f(XIN)=4MHz 0.5 1.0 mA f(XIN)=12.5MHz 2.5 5.0 mA f(XIN)=12.5MHz (in WIT state) 1.5 3.0 mA mA f(XIN)=4MHz 1.2 1.6 f(XIN)=8MHz 0.5 1.0 mA f(XIN)=8MHz (in WIT state) 0.3 0.6 mA f(XIN)=4MHz 0.3 0.6 mA f(XIN)=stop 17 26 in WIT state 5.5 11 f(XIN)=stop 7.0 14 in WIT state 3.5 7.0 540 VCC=5V 270 VCC=2.5V 35 90 VCC=2.5V (in WIT state) 25 75 µA µA µA µA µA µA µA Ta=25°C 0.1 1.0 µA 10 µA Ta=85°C f(XIN)=12.5 MHz, VCC=5 V in frequency/2, 4 or 8 mode 0.5 mA f(XIN)= stop, VCC = 5 V in on-chip oscillator operating 0.5 mA f(XIN) = stop, VCC = 5 V in low-speed mode 0.4 mA A/D Converter Characteristics Table 28 A/D converter recommended operating condition (Vcc = 2.0 to 5.5 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, output transistors in cut-off state, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Parameter VCC Power source voltage VIH “H” input voltage ADKEY0 VIL “L” input voltage ADKEY0 f(φAD) (1) AD converter clock frequency (Low-speed • on-chip oscillator mode excluded) Test conditions 2.0 5.0 Max. Unit 5.5 V 0.9VCC VCC V 0 0.7 × VCC−0.5 V 4.5V < VCC ≤ 5.5V 6.25 MHz 4.0 MHz 2.0V < VCC ≤ 4.0V VCC MHz 1. Confirm the recommended operating condition for main clock input frequency. Page 103 of 134 Typ. 4.0V < VCC ≤ 4.5V NOTE: Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Limits Min. 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION Table 29 A/D converter characteristics (Vcc = 2.0 to 5.5 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, output transistors in cut-off state, low-speed • on-chip oscillator mode included, unless otherwise noted) Symbol − ABS Parameter Limits Test conditions Min. Typ. Max. Unit Resolution 10 Bits Absolute accuracy 10bitAD 4.5V < VCC ≤ 5.5V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8 ≤ 6.25MHz (quantification error mode excluded) 4.0V < VCC ≤ 4.5V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8 ≤ 4MHz 4 LSB 2.2V ≤ VCC ≤ 4.0V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8 ≤ VccMHz 2.0V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V, AD conversion clock=f(OCO)/8, f(OCO)/32 4.5V < VCC ≤ 5.5V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8 ≤ 6.25MHz 8bitAD mode 2 4.0V < VCC ≤ 4.5V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8 ≤ 4MHz 2.2V < VCC ≤ 4.0V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8 ≤ VccMHz 2.0V ≤ VCC ≤ 2.2V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8 ≤ (6Vcc−11)MHz 2.0V ≤ VCC ≤ 2.2V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/8 ≤ VccMHz 2.0V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V, AD conversion clock=f(OCO)/8, f(OCO)/32 tCONV Conversion time(1) 10bitAD mode tc(φAD)×61 tc(φAD)×62 8bitAD mode tc(φAD)×49 tc(φAD)×50 RLADDER Ladder resistor IVREF Reference input current VREF=5.0V IIA Analog input current µs 12 35 100 50 150 200 kΩ µA 5.0 µA NOTES: 1. tc(φAD): one cycle of AD conversion clock. AD conversion clock can be selected from φSOURCE/2 or φSOURCE/8. φSOURCE represents the XIN input in the frequency/2, 4 or 8 mode and internal on-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode or the low-speed mode. When the A/D conversion is executed in the frequency/2 mode, frequency/4 mode, or frequency/8 mode, set f(XIN) ≥ 500 kHz. Relationship among AD conversion clock frequency, power source voltage, AD conversion mode and absolute accuracy. AD conversion clock frequency 10bitAD=4LSB 8bitAD=2LSB [MHz] 6.25 AD conversion clock •frequency/2 mode, frequency/4 and frequency/8 mode: f(XIN)/2 or f(XIN)/8 4.0 f(XIN)/8 8bitAD=2LSB 2.2 2.0 f(XIN)/2 or f(XIN)/8 10bitAD=4LSB 8bitAD=2LSB f(XIN)/2 or f(XIN)/8 8bitAD=2LSB 1.0 (Note) 0 1.8 2.0 2.2 4.0 4.5 Power source voltage V CC Note: f(XIN) ≥ 500kHz Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 AD conversion clock •Low-speed mode and on-chip oscillator mode: f(OCO)/8 or f(OCO)/32 Page 104 of 134 5.5 [V] 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION Timing Requirements And Switching Characteristics Table 30 Timing requirements (1) (Vcc = 4.0 to 5.5 V, Vss = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Limits Parameter tW(RESET) Reset input “L” pulse width tC(XIN) Main clock input cycle time tWH(XIN) Main clock input “H” pulse width tWL(XIN) Main clock input “L” pulse width Min. Typ. Max. Unit 4.5V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V (1) 62.5 µs ns 4.0V ≤ VCC < 4.5V 125 ns 25 ns 4.0V ≤ VCC < 4.5V 50 ns 4.5V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V (2) 25 ns 4.0V ≤ VCC < 4.5V 50 ns 2 4.5V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V (2) tC(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input cycle time 250 ns tWH(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input “H” pulse width 105 ns tWL(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input “L” pulse width 105 ns tWH(INT) INT00, INT01, INT10, INT11, INT2 input “H” pulse width 80 ns tWL(INT) INT00, INT01, INT10, INT11, INT2 input “L” pulse width 80 ns tC(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock input cycle time (3) 800 ns tWH(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock input “H” pulse width (3) 370 ns tWL(SCLK1) (3) 370 ns tsu(RXD-SCLK1) Serial I/O1 input setup time 220 ns th(SCLK1-RXD) Serial I/O1 input hold time 100 ns tC(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input cycle time 1000 ns tWH(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input “H” pulse width 400 ns tWL(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input “L” pulse width 400 ns tsu(SIN2-SCLK2) Serial I/O2 input setup time 200 ns th(SCLK2-SIN2) 200 ns Serial I/O1 clock input “L” pulse width Serial I/O2 input hold time NOTES: 1. 80 ns in the frequency/2 mode. 2. 32 ns in the frequency/2 mode. 3. When bit 6 of address 001A16 is “1” (clock synchronous). Divide this value by four when bit 6 of address 001A16 is “0” (UART). Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 105 of 134 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION Table 31 Timing requirements (2) (VCC = 1.8 to 4.0 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Max. Unit µs ns VCC < 2.0V 2.0V ≤ VCC < 4.0V VCC < 2.0V Main clock input “L” pulse width 2.0V ≤ VCC < 4.0V VCC < 2.0V CNTR0, CNTR1 input cycle time 2.0V ≤ VCC < 4.0V VCC < 2.0V 166 ns 50 ns Main clock input cycle time (XIN input) tC(CNTR) Typ. 125 Reset input “L” pulse width tWL(XIN) Min. 2.0V ≤ VCC < 4.0V tW(RESET) tC(XIN) tWH(XIN) Limits Parameter 2 Main clock input “H” pulse width 70 ns 50 ns 70 ns 1000/VCC ns 1000/(5 × VCC-8) ns tWH(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input “H” pulse width tc(CNTR)/2-20 ns tWL(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input “L” pulse width tc(CNTR)/2-20 ns tWH(INT) INT00, INT01, INT10, INT11, INT2 input “H” pulse width 230 ns tWL(INT) INT00, INT01, INT10, INT11, INT2 input “L” pulse width 230 ns tC(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock input cycle time (1) 2000 ns tWH(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock input “H” pulse width (1) 950 ns tWL(SCLK1) (1) 950 ns tsu(RXD-SCLK1) Serial I/O1 input setup time 400 ns th(SCLK1-RXD) Serial I/O1 input hold time 200 ns tC(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input cycle time 2000 ns Serial I/O1 clock input “L” pulse width tWH(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input “H” pulse width 950 ns tWL(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input “L” pulse width 950 ns tsu(SIN2-SCLK2) Serial I/O2 input setup time 400 ns th(SCLK2-SIN2) 200 ns Serial I/O2 input hold time NOTE: 1. When bit 6 of address 001A16 is “1” (clock synchronous). Divide this value by four when bit 6 of address 001A16 is “0” (UART). Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 106 of 134 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION Table 32 Switching characteristics (1) (Vcc = 4.0 to 5.5 V, Vss = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Limits Parameter Min. Typ tWH(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output “H” pulse width tc(SCLK1)/2-30 tWL(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output “L” pulse width tc(SCLK1)/2-30 td(SCLK1-TxD) Serial I/O1 output delay time (1) tv(SCLK1-TxD) Serial I/O1 output valid time (1) tr(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output rising time Max. Unit ns ns 140 ns 30 ns 30 ns −30 ns tf(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output falling time tWH(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output “H” pulse width tc(SCLK2)/2-30 tWL(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output “L” pulse width tc(SCLK2)/2-30 tf(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output falling time td(SCLK2-SOUT2) Serial I/O2 output delay time tv(SCLK2-SOUT2) Serial I/O2 output valid time ns ns 40 140 −30 ns ns ns NOTE: 1. The P41/TxD P-channel output disable bit (bit 4 of address 001B16) of UART control register is “0”. Table 33 Switching characteristics (2) (VCC = 1.8 to 4.0 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Limits Parameter Min. Typ tWH(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output “H” pulse width tc(SCLK1)/2-80 tWL(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output “L” pulse width tc(SCLK1)/2-80 td(SCLK1-TxD) Serial I/O1 output delay time tv(SCLK1-TxD) Serial I/O1 output valid time (1) tr(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output rising time Max. ns ns (1) 350 ns 80 ns 80 ns -30 ns tf(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output falling time tWH(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output “H” pulse width tc(SCLK2)/2-80 tWL(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output “L” pulse width tc(SCLK2)/2-80 tf(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output falling time td(SCLK2-SOUT2) Serial I/O2 output delay time tv(SCLK2-SOUT2) Serial I/O2 output valid time ns ns 80 350 -30 1. The P41/TxD P-channel output disable bit (bit 4 of address 001B16) of UART control register is “0”. 1kΩ Measurement output pin 100pF CMOS output 100pF N-channel open-drain output (Note) Note: When bit 4 of the UART control register (address 001B16) is “1.” (N-channel open-drain output mode) Fig 95. Circuit for measuring output switching characteristics Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 107 of 134 ns ns ns NOTE: Measurement output pin Unit 38D5 Group QzROM VERSION tC(CNTR) tWL(CNTR) tWH(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 0.8VCC 0.2VCC tWH(INT) INT00, INT01 INT10, INT11 INT2 tWL(INT) 0.8VCC 0.2VCC tW(RESET) RESET 0.8VCC 0.2VCC tC(XIN) tWL(XIN) tWH(XIN) 0.8VCC XIN 0.2VCC tC(SCLK1), tC(SCLK2) SCLK1 SCLK2 tf tWL(SCLK1), tWL(SCLK2) tr 0.8VCC 0.2VCC tsu(RXD-SCLK1), tsu(SIN2-SCLK2) RXD SIN2 th(SCLK1-RXD), th(SCLK2-SIN2) 0.8VCC 0.2VCC td(SCLK1-TXD), td(SCLK2-SOUT2) TXD SOUT2 Fig 96. Timing diagram Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 tWH(SCLK1), tWH(SCLK2) Page 108 of 134 tV(SCLK1-TXD), tV(SCLK2-SOUT2) 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION FLASH MEMORY VERSION ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS Absolute Maximum Ratings Table 34 Absolute maximum ratings Symbol Parameter Conditions VCC Power source voltage VI Input voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P70−P74 VI Input voltage VL1 VI Input voltage VL2 VI Input voltage VL3 VI Input voltage C1, C2 VI Input voltage RESET, XIN, CNVSS VO Output voltage C1, C2 VO Output voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 All voltages are based on VSS. When an input voltage is measured, output transistors are cut off. Ratings −0.3 to 6.5 −0.3 to VCC+0.3 Unit −0.3 to VL2 V VL1 to VL3 V V V VL2 to 6.5 V −0.3 to 6.5 V −0.3 to VCC+0.3 V −0.3 to 6.5 V At output port −0.3 to VCC+0.3 V At segment output −0.3 to VL3+0.3 V VO Output voltage P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 −0.3 to VCC+0.3 V VO Output voltage VL3 Output voltage VL2, SEG32−SEG35, COM0−COM3 −0.3 to 6.5 −0.3 to VL3+0.3 V VO VO Output voltage XOUT V Pd Power dissipation Topr Operating temperature Tstg Storage temperature −0.3 to VCC+0.3 300 −20 to 85 −40 to 125 Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Ta=25°C Page 109 of 134 V mW °C °C 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION Recommended Operating Conditions Table 35 Recommended operating conditions (1) (VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C unless otherwise noted) Symbol VCC Limits Parameter Power source voltage(1) VL1 input voltage Unit 4.5 5.5 V 4.0 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 4MHz 2.7 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 16MHz 4.5 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8MHz 2.7 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 16MHz 4.5 5.5 V f(XIN) ≤ 8MHz 2.7 5.5 V Low-speed mode 2.7 5.5 V On-chip oscillator mode 2.7 5.5 V 2.1 V VCC V AVSS VCC V Frequency/8 mode VLI Max. f(XIN) ≤ 12.5MHz Frequency/4 mode Power source voltage Typ. f(XIN) ≤ 8MHz Frequency/2 mode (2) VSS Min. 0 Voltage multiplier is used 1.3 1.8 VREF A/D converter reference voltage AVSS Analog power source voltage VIA Analog input voltage AN0−AN7 VIH “H” input voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P24−P27, P30−P37,P41, P43, P50−P57, P60 (CM4=0), P61, P65, P72−P74 0.7VCC VCC V VIH “H” input voltage P20−P23, P40, P42, P44−P47, P62−P64, P66, P67, P70, P71 0.8VCC VCC V VIH “H” input voltage RESET 0.8VCC VCC V VIH “H” input voltage XIN 0.8VCC VCC V VIL “L” input voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P24−P27, P30−P37, P41, P43, P50−P57, P60 (CM4=0), P61, P65, P72−P74 0 0.3VCC V VIL “L” input voltage P20−P23, P40, P42, P44−P47, P62−P64, P66, P67, P70, P71 0 0.2VCC V VIL “L” input voltage RESET 0 0.2VCC V XIN 0 0.2VCC V VIL “L” input voltage 2.7 V 0 NOTES: 1. When the A/D converter is used, refer to the recommended operating conditions of the A/D converter. 2. 12.5 MHz < f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz is not available in the frequency/2 mode. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 110 of 134 V 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION Table 36 Recommended operating conditions (2) (VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Parameter Min. Limits Typ. Max. −40 Unit ΣOH(peak) “H” total peak output current (1) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P72−P74 ΣOH(peak) “H” total peak output current (1) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67 −40 mA ΣOL(peak) “L” total peak output current (1) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P72−P74 40 mA ΣOL(peak) “L” total peak output current (1) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60, P61 40 mA ΣOL(peak) “L” total peak output current (1) P62−P67 110 mA ΣOH(avg) “H” total average output current (1) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P72−P74 −20 mA ΣOH(avg) “H” total average output current (1) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67 −20 mA ΣOL(avg) “L” total average output current (1) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37, P72−P74 20 mA ΣOL(avg) “L” total average output current (1) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60, P61 20 mA ΣOL(avg) “L” total average output current (1) P62−P67 90 mA IOH(peak) “H” peak output current (2) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 −2 mA IOH(peak) “H” peak output current (2) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 −5 mA IOL(peak) “L” peak output current (2) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 5 mA IOL(peak) “L” peak output current (2) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60, P61, P72−P74 10 mA IOL(peak) “L” peak output current (2) P62−P67 30 mA IOH(avg) “H” average output current (3) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 −1.0 mA IOH(avg) “H” average output current (3) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 −2.5 mA IOL(avg) “L” average output current (3) P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 2.5 mA IOL(avg) “L” average output current (3) P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 5.0 mA IOL(avg) “L” average output current (3) P62−P67 15 mA mA NOTES: 1. The total output current is the sum of all the currents flowing through all the applicable ports. The total average current is an average value measured over 100 ms. The total peak current is the peak value of all the currents. 2. The peak output current is the peak current flowing in each port. 3. The average output current is average value measured over 100 ms. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 111 of 134 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION Table 37 Recommended operating conditions (3) (VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol f(CNTR0) f(CNTR1) Parameter Limits Conditions Timer X and Timer Y Input frequency (duty cycle 50%) Min. Typ. Max. 4.5V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V 6.25 4.0V ≤ VCC < 4.5V 2×Vcc−4 MHz 2.7V ≤ VCC < 4.0V Vcc MHz Timer X, Timer Y, 4.5V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V Timer 1, Timer 2, 4.0V ≤ VCC < 4.5V Timer 3, Timer 4 clock input frequency (Count source frequency of each timer) 2.7V ≤ VCC < 4.0V f(Tclk) f(φ) System clock φ frequency (1) Main clock input frequency (duty cycle 50%) (2)(3) f(XCIN) Sub-clock oscillation frequency (duty cycle 50%) (4)(5) MHz 16 MHz 4×Vcc−8 MHz 2×Vcc MHz 4.5V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V 6.25 MHz 4.0V ≤ VCC < 4.5V 4 MHz 2.7V ≤ VCC < 4.0V f(XIN) Unit 4.5V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V 1.0 2.7V ≤ VCC < 4.5V 1.0 32.768 Vcc MHz 16 MHz 8.0 MHz 80 kHz NOTES: Relationship between system clock φ frequency and power source voltage is shown in the graph below. When the A/D converter is used, refer to the recommended operating conditions of the A/D converter. 12.5 MHz < f(XIN) ≤ 16 MHz is not available in the frequency/2 mode. The oscillation start voltage and the oscillation start time differ depending on factors such as the oscillator, circuit constants, and operating temperature range. Note that oscillation start may be particularly difficult at low voltage when using a high-frequency oscillator. 5. When using the microcomputer in low-speed mode, set the clock input oscillation frequency on condition that f(XCIN) < f(XIN)/3. 1. 2. 3. 4. <System clock φ frequency> <Main clock XIN frequency> [MHz] 16 [MHz] Main clock XIN frequency System clock φ frequency 6.25 4.0 2.7 8.0 1.0 0 4.0 2.7 4.5 Power source voltage Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 112 of 134 5.5 [V] 0 2.7 4.5 Power source voltage 5.5 [V] 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION Electrical Characteristics Table 38 Symbol Electrical characteristics (1) (VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Parameter Test conditions IOH= −2.5mA Limits Min. Typ. Max. VCC−2.0 V IOH= −5mA VCC−2.0 V IOH= −1.25mA VCC−0.5 V VOH “H” output voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 VOH “H” output voltage P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 (1) “L” output voltage P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 IOL=5mA 2.0 IOL=1.25mA 0.5 “L” output voltage P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 (1) IOL=10mA 2.0 IOL=2.5mA 0.5 IOL=15mA 2.0 VOL VOL Unit V V V VOL “L” output voltage P62−P67 VT+−VT− Hysteresis INT00, INT01, INT10, INT11, INT2, CNTR0, CNTR1, KW0−KW7 0.5 V VT+−VT− Hysteresis SIN2, SCLK1, SCLK2, RxD 0.5 V VT+−VT− 0.5 Hysteresis RESET V IIH “H” input current P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 VI=VCC 5.0 µA IIH “H” input current P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P70−P74 VI=VCC 5.0 µA IIH “H” input current RESET, CNVSS VI=VCC 5.0 µA IIH “H” input current XIN VI=VCC IIL “L” input current P00−P07, P10−P17, P20−P27, P30−P37 VI=VSS Pull-up “OFF” IIL “L” input current P40−P47, P50−P57, P60−P67, P72−P74 µA 4.0 −5.0 VCC=5V, VI=VSS Pull-up “ON” −60 −120 −240 VCC=3V, VI=VSS Pull-up “ON” −25 −50 −100 VI=VSS Pull-up “OFF” −5.0 VCC=5V, VI=VSS Pull-up “ON” −30 −70 −140 VCC=3V, VI=VSS Pull-up “ON” −6.5 −25 −45 IIL “L” input current RESET, CNVSS IIL “L” input current XIN VI=VSS f(OCO) On-chip oscillator frequency VCC=5V, Ta=25°C VI=VSS 5000 µA µA µA µA µA −5.0 µA 7500 kHz −4.0 2500 µA µA NOTE: 1. When the port Xc switch bit (bit 4 of address 003B16) of CPU mode register is “1”, the drivability of P61 is different from the above. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 113 of 134 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION Table 39 Electrical characteristics (2) (Vcc = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz, output transistors in the cut-off state, A/D converter stopped, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Parameter Limits Test conditions VRAM RAM hold voltage When clock is stopped ICC Power source current Frequency/2 mode Vcc=5.0V Vcc=2.7V Frequency/4 mode Vcc=5.0V Vcc=2.7V Frequency/8 mode Vcc=5.0V Vcc=2.7V Low-speed mode Vcc=5.0V Min. Typ. 2.2 Max. 5.5 V f(XIN)=12.5MHz 4.0 7.0 mA f(XIN)=12.5MHz (in WIT state) 2.0 3.5 mA f(XIN)=4MHz 2.0 3.5 mA f(XIN)=4MHz 1.5 3 mA f(XIN)=4MHz (in WIT state) 1.0 2.5 mA mA f(XIN)=2MHz 1.0 2.5 f(XIN)=12.5MHz 3.2 5.6 mA f(XIN)=12.5MHz (in WIT state) 1.6 3.2 mA mA f(XIN)=4MHz 1.6 3.2 f(XIN)=8MHz 1.6 3.2 mA f(XIN)=8MHz (in WIT state) 1.0 2.5 mA mA f(XIN)=4MHz 1.0 2.5 f(XIN)=12.5MHz 2.5 5 mA f(XIN)=12.5MHz (in WIT state) 1.5 3 mA mA f(XIN)=4MHz 1.5 3 f(XIN)=8MHz 1.5 3 mA f(XIN)=8MHz (in WIT state) 1.0 2.5 mA f(XIN)=4MHz 1.0 2.5 mA f(XIN)=stop 400 800 µA 4.0 10 Ta=25°C in WIT state Ta=85°C Vcc=2.7V Unit 20 f(XIN)=stop Ta=25°C in WIT state µA 300 600 µA 3.7 9 µA Ta=85°C 18 500 1000 All oscillations stopped (in STP state) Ta=25°C 0.6 3.0 Ta=85°C 1.0 Current increased at A/D converter operating f(XIN)=12.5MHz, VCC=5V in frequency/2, 4 or 8 mode 1.0 µA µA µA µA µA mA f(XIN)=stop, VCC=5V in on-chip oscillator operating 1.0 mA f(XIN)=stop, VCC=5V in low-speed mode 0.8 mA On-chip oscillator mode f(XIN), f(XCIN), stop Vcc=5.0V 600 1200 Vcc=2.7V 500 1000 Vcc=2.7V (in WIT state) A/D Converter Characteristics Table 40 A/D converter recommended operating condition (Vcc = 2.7 to 5.5 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, output transistors in cut-off state, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Parameter Test conditions VCC Power source voltage VIH “H” input voltage ADKEY0 VIL “L” input voltage ADKEY0 f(φAD) AD converter clock frequency (1) (Low-speed • on-chip oscillator mode excluded) Limits Min. Typ. 2.7 5.0 Unit 5.5 V 0.9VCC VCC V 0 0.7 × VCC − 0.5 V 6.25 MHz 4.0V < VCC ≤ 4.5V 4.0 MHz 2.7V < VCC ≤ 4.0V VCC MHz 4.5V < VCC ≤ 5.5V NOTE: 1. Confirm the recommended operating condition for main clock input frequency. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Max. Page 114 of 134 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION Table 41 A/D converter characteristics (Vcc = 2.7 to 5.5 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, output transistors in cut-off state, low-speed • on-chip oscillator mode included, unless otherwise noted) Symbol − ABS Parameter Limits Test conditions Min. Typ. Max. Unit Resolution 10 Bits Absolute accuracy 10bitAD 4.5V < VCC ≤ 5.5V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8≤6.25MHz (quantification error mode excluded) 4.0V < VCC ≤ 4.5V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8≤4MHz 4 LSB 2.7V ≤ VCC ≤ 4.0V, AD conversion clock, f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8≤VccMHz 2.7V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V, f(OCO)/8, f(OCO)/32 4.5V < VCC ≤ 5.5V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8≤6.25MHz 8bitAD mode 2 4.0V < VCC ≤ 4.5V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8≤4MHz 2.7V ≤ VCC ≤ 4.0V, AD conversion clock=f(XIN)/2, f(XIN)/8≤VccMHz 2.7V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V, f(OCO)/8, f(OCO)/32 tCONV Conversion time(1) 10bitAD mode tc(φAD) × 61 tc(φAD) × 62 8bitAD mode tc(φAD) × 49 tc(φAD) × 50 RLADDER Ladder resistor IVREF Reference input current IIA Analog input current VREF=5V µs 12 35 100 50 150 200 kΩ µA 5.0 µA NOTE: 1. tc(φAD): one cycle of AD conversion clock. AD conversion clock can be selected from φSOURCE/2 or φSOURCE/8. φSOURCE represents the XIN input in the frequency/2, 4 or 8 mode and internal on-chip oscillator divided by 4 in the on-chip oscillator mode or the low-speed mode. When the A/D conversion is executed in the frequency/2 mode, frequency/4 mode, or frequency/8 mode, set f(XIN) ≥ 500 kHz. Relationship among AD conversion clock frequency, power source voltage, AD conversion mode and absolute accuracy. 10bitAD=4LSB 8bitAD=2LSB AD conversion clock • Low-speed mode and on-chip oscillator mode: f(OCO)/8 or f(OCO)/32 AD conversion clock frequency [MHz] 6.25 4.0 AD conversion clock • frequency/2 mode, frequency/4 and frequency/8 mode: f(XIN)/2 or f(XIN)/8 2.7 f(XIN)/2 or f(XIN)/8 10bitAD=4LSB 8bitAD=2LSB (Note) 0 2.7 4.0 4.5 Power source voltage VCC Note: f(XIN) ≥ 500kHz Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 115 of 134 5.5 [V] 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION Timing Requirements And Switching Characteristics Table 42 Power supply circuit characteristics (Vcc = 2.7 to 5.5 V, Vss = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol td(P-R) Parameter Test conditions Internal power source voltage stabilizes time at power-on 2.7 ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V Limits Min. Typ. Unit Max. 2 ms Table 43 Timing requirements (1) (Vcc = 4.0 to 5.5 V, Vss = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Parameter tW(RESET) Reset input “L” pulse width tC(XIN) Main clock input cycle time tWH(XIN) Main clock input “H” pulse width tWL(XIN) Main clock input “L” pulse width tC(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input cycle time Limits Min. Typ. Max. Unit 4.5V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V (1) 62.5 µs ns 4.0V ≤ VCC < 4.5V 125 ns 4.5V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V (2) 25 ns 4.0V ≤ VCC < 4.5V 50 ns 4.5V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V (2) 25 ns 2 4.0V ≤ VCC < 4.5V 50 ns 250 ns tWH(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input “H” pulse width 105 ns tWL(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input “L” pulse width 105 ns tWH(INT) INT00, INT01, INT10, INT11, INT2 input “H” pulse width 80 ns tWL(INT) INT00, INT01, INT10, INT11, INT2 input “L” pulse width 80 ns tC(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock input cycle time (3) 800 ns tWH(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock input “H” pulse width (3) 370 ns tWL(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock input “L” pulse width (3) 370 ns tsu(RxD-SCLK1) Serial I/O1 input setup time 220 ns th(SCLK1-RxD) Serial I/O1 input hold time 100 ns ns tC(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input cycle time 1000 tWH(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input “H” pulse width 400 ns tWL(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input “L” pulse width 400 ns tsu(SIN2-SCLK2) Serial I/O2 input setup time 200 ns th(SCLK2-SIN2) Serial I/O2 input hold time 200 ns NOTES: 1. 80 ns in the frequency/2 mode. 2. 32 ns in the frequency/2 mode. 3. When bit 6 of address 001A16 is “1” (clock synchronous). Divide this value by four when bit 6 of address 001A16 is “0” (UART). Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 116 of 134 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION Table 44 Timing requirements (2) (VCC = 2.7 to 4.0 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Parameter Limits Min. Typ. Max. Unit tW(RESET) Reset input “L” pulse width 2 µs tC(XIN) Main clock input cycle time (XIN input) 125 ns tWH(XIN) Main clock input “H” pulse width 50 ns tWL(XIN) Main clock input “L” pulse width 50 ns tC(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input cycle time 1000/VCC ns tWH(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input “H” pulse width tc(CNTR)/2−20 ns tWL(CNTR) CNTR0, CNTR1 input “L” pulse width tc(CNTR)/2−20 ns tWH(INT) INT00, INT01, INT10, INT11, INT2 input “H” pulse width 230 ns tWL(INT) INT00, INT01, INT10, INT11, INT2 input “L” pulse width 230 ns tC(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock input cycle time 2000 ns tWH(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock input “H” pulse width 950 ns tWL(SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock input “L” pulse width 950 ns tsu(RXD-SCLK1) Serial I/O1 input setup time 400 ns th(SCLK1-RXD) Serial I/O1 input hold time 200 ns tC(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input cycle time 2000 ns tWH(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input “H” pulse width 950 ns tWL(SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock input “L” pulse width 950 ns tsu(SIN2-SCLK2) Serial I/O2 input setup time 400 ns th(SCLK2-SIN2) Serial I/O2 input hold time 200 ns NOTE: 1. When bit 6 of address 001A16 is “1” (clock synchronous). Divide this value by four when bit 6 of address 001A16 is “0” (UART). Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 117 of 134 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION Table 45 Switching characteristics (1) (Vcc = 4.0 to 5.5 V, Vss = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Limits Parameter Min. tWH (SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output “H” pulse width tC(SCLK1)/2−30 tWL (SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output “L” pulse width tC(SCLK1)/2−30 td (SCLK1-TXD) Serial I/O1 output delay time (1) Serial I/O1 output valid time (1) tr (SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output rising time tf (SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output falling time tWH (SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output “H” pulse width tC(SCLK2)/2−30 tWL (SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output “L” pulse width tC(SCLK2)/2−30 tf (SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output falling time td (SCLK2-SOUT2) Serial I/O2 output delay time Serial I/O2 output valid time Max. Unit ns ns 140 ns 30 ns 30 ns −30 tV (SCLK1-TXD) tV (SCLK2-SOUT2) Typ ns ns ns 40 ns 140 ns −30 ns NOTE: 1. The P41/TxD P-channel output disable bit (bit 4 of address 001B16) of UART control register is “0”. Table 46 Switching characteristics (2) (VCC = 2.7 to 4.0 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = −20 to 85°C, unless otherwise noted) Symbol Limits Parameter Min. tWH (SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output “H” pulse width tC(SCLK1)/2−80 tWL (SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output “L” pulse width tC(SCLK1)/2−80 td (SCLK1-TXD) Serial I/O1 output delay time (1) tV (SCLK1-TXD) Serial I/O1 output valid time (1) Typ Max. Unit ns ns 350 −30 ns ns tr (SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output rising time 80 ns tf (SCLK1) Serial I/O1 clock output falling time 80 ns tWH (SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output “H” pulse width tC(SCLK2)/2−80 tWL (SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output “L” pulse width tC(SCLK2)/2−80 tf (SCLK2) Serial I/O2 clock output falling time 80 td (SCLK2-SOUT2) Serial I/O2 output delay time 350 tV (SCLK2-SOUT2) Serial I/O2 output valid time ns ns −30 1. The P41/TxD P-channel output disable bit (bit 4 of address 001B16) of UART control register is “0”. 1kΩ Measurement output pin 100pF CMOS output Fig 97. Circuit for measuring output switching characteristics Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 118 of 134 ns ns NOTE: Measurement output pin ns 100pF N-channel open-drain output (Note) 38D5 Group FLASH MEMORY VERSION tc(CNTR) tWL(CNTR) tWH(CNTR) 0.8VCC 0.2VCC CNTR0, CNTR1 tWL(INT) tWH(INT) INT00,INT01 INT10,INT11 INT2 0.8VCC 0.2VCC tw(RESET) RESET 0.8VCC 0.2VCC tc(XIN) tWL(XIN) tWH(XIN) 0.8VCC 0.2VCC XIN tC(SCLK1), tC(SCLK2) tf SCLK1 SCLK2 tWL(SCLK1), tWL(SCLK2) tWH(SCLK1), tWH(SCLK2) 0.8VCC 0.2VCC tsu(RXD-SCLK1), tsu(SIN2-SCLK2) RXD SIN2 th(SCLK1-RXD), th(SCLK2-SIN2) 0.8VCC 0.2VCC td(SCLK1-TXD), td(SCLK2-SOUT2) TXD SOUT2 Fig 98. Timing diagram (in single-chip mode) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 tr Page 119 of 134 tV(SCLK1-TXD), tV(SCLK2-SOUT2) 38D5 Group PACKAGE OUTLINE Diagrams showing the latest package dimensions and mounting information are available in the “Packages” section of the Renesas Technology website. JEITA Package Code P-QFP80-14x20-0.80 RENESAS Code PRQP0080GB-A Previous Code 80P6N-A MASS[Typ.] 1.6g HD *1 D 64 41 65 HE NOTE) 1. DIMENSIONS "*1" AND "*2" DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH. 2. DIMENSION "*3" DOES NOT INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET. ZE *2 E 40 Reference Symbol 80 25 1 ZD 24 D E A2 HD HE A A1 bp c c Index mark A A2 F *3 y bp L A1 e Detail F Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 120 of 134 e y ZD ZE L Dimension in Millimeters Min Nom Max 19.8 20.0 20.2 13.8 14.0 14.2 2.8 22.5 22.8 23.1 16.5 16.8 17.1 3.05 0.1 0.2 0 0.3 0.35 0.45 0.13 0.15 0.2 0° 10° 0.65 0.8 0.95 0.10 0.8 1.0 0.4 0.6 0.8 38D5 Group JEITA Package Code P-LQFP80-12x12-0.50 RENESAS Code PLQP0080KB-A Previous Code 80P6Q-A MASS[Typ.] 0.5g HD *1 D 60 41 NOTE) 1. DIMENSIONS "*1" AND "*2" DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH. 2. DIMENSION "*3" DOES NOT INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET. 40 61 bp E c *2 HE c1 b1 Reference Symbol ZE Terminal cross section 80 21 1 20 ZD Index mark bp c A *3 A1 y e A2 F L x L1 Detail F Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 121 of 134 D E A2 HD HE A A1 bp b1 c c1 e x y ZD ZE L L1 Dimension in Millimeters Min Nom Max 11.9 12.0 12.1 11.9 12.0 12.1 1.4 13.8 14.0 14.2 13.8 14.0 14.2 1.7 0.1 0.2 0 0.15 0.20 0.25 0.18 0.09 0.145 0.20 0.125 0° 10° 0.5 0.08 0.08 1.25 1.25 0.3 0.5 0.7 1.0 38D5 Group APPENDIX Note on Programming 1. Processor Status Register (1) Initialization of the processor status register It is required to initialize the processor status register (PS) flags which affect program execution. It is particularly essential to initialize the T and D flags because of their effect on calculations. Initialize these flags at the beginning of the program. <Reason> At a reset, the contents of the processor status register (PS) are undefined except for the I flag which is “1”. Reset Initialize the flags Main program Fig. 99 Initialization of processor status register flags (2) How to refer the processor status register To refer the contents of the processor status register (PS), execute the PHP instruction once and then read the contents of (S+1). If necessary, execute the PLP instruction to return the stored PS to its original status. (S) (S) + 1 Stored PS Fig. 100 Stack memory contents after PHP instruction execution Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 122 of 134 2. Decimal Calculations (1) Instructions for decimal calculations To perform decimal calculations, set the decimal mode (D) flag to “1” with the SED instruction and execute the ADC or SBC instruction. In that case, after the ADC or SBC instruction, execute another instruction before the SEC, CLC, or CLD instruction. Set the decimal mode (D) flag to “1” Execute the ADC or SBC instruction NOP Execute the SEC, CLC, or CLD instruction Fig. 101 Instructions for decimal calculations (2) Status flag at decimal calculations When the ADC or SBC instruction is executed in decimal mode (D flag = “1”), three of the status flags (N, V, and Z) are disabled. The carry (C) flag is set to “1” if a carry is generated and is cleared to “0” if a borrow is generated as a result of a calculation, so it can be used to determine whether the calculation has generated a carry or borrow. Initialize the C flag before each calculation. 38D5 Group 3. JMP Instruction When using the JMP instruction (indirect addressing mode), do not specify the address where “FF16” is allocated to the loworder 8 bits as the operand. 4. Multiplication and Division Instructions (1) The MUL and DIV instructions are not affected by the T and D flags. (2) Executing these instructions does not change the contents of the processor status register. 5. Read-Modify-Write Instruction Do not execute any read-modify-write instruction to the read invalid (address) SFR. The read-modify-write instruction reads 1-byte of data from memory, modifies the data, and writes 1-byte the data to the original memory. In the 740 Family, the read-modify-write instructions are the following: (1) Bit handling instructions: CLB, SEB (2) Shift and rotate instructions: ASL, LSR, ROL, ROR, RRF (3) Add and subtract instructions: DEC, INC (4) Logical operation instructions (1’s complement): COM Although not the read-modify-write instructions, add and subtract/logical operation instructions (ADC, SBC, AND, EOR, and ORA) when T flag = “1” operate in the way as the readmodify-write instruction. Do not execute them to the read invalid SFR. <Reason> When the read-modify-write instruction is executed to the read invalid SFR, the following may result: As reading is invalid, the read value is undefined. The instruction modifies this undefined value and writes it back, so the written value will be indeterminate. Notes on Peripheral Functions Notes on I/O Ports 1. Use in Stand-By State When using the MCU in stand-by state* 1 for low-power consumption, do not leave the input level of an I/O port undefined. Be especially careful to the I/O ports for the Nchannel open-drain. In this case, pull-up (connect to Vcc) or pull-down (connect to Vss) these ports through a resistor. When determining a resistance value, note the following: • External circuit • Variation in the output level during ordinary operation When using a built-in pull-up resistor, note variations in current values: • When setting as an input port: Fix the input level • When setting as an output port: Prevent current from flowing out externally. <Reason> Even if a port is set to output by the direction register, when the content of the port latch is “1”, the transistor becomes the OFF state, which allows the port to be in the high-impedance state. This may cause the level to be undefined depending on external circuits. As described above, if the input level of an I/O port is left undefined, the power source current may flow because the potential applied to the input buffer in the MCU will be unstable. *1 Stand-by state: Stop mode by executing the STP instruction Wait mode by executing the WIT instruction 2. Modifying Output Data with Bit Handling Instruction When the port latch of an I/O port is modified with the bit handling instruction* 1 , the value of an unspecified bit may change. <Reason> I/O ports can be set to input mode or output mode in byte units. When the port register is read or written, the following will be operated: • Port as input mode Read: Read the pin level Write: Write to the port latch • Port as output mode Read: Read the port latch or peripheral function output (specifications vary depending on the port) Write: Write to the port latch (output the content of the port latch from the pin) Meanwhile, the bit handling instructions are the read-modifywrite instructions*2. Executing the bit handling instruction to the port register allows reading and writing a bit unspecified with the instruction at the same time. If an unspecified bit is set to input mode, the pin level is read and the value is written to the port latch. At this time, if the original content of the port latch and the pin level do not match, the content of the port latch changes. If an unspecified bit is set to output mode, the port latch is normally read, but the peripheral function output is read in some ports and the value is written to the port latch. At this time, if the original content of the port latch and the peripheral function output do not match, the content of the port latch changes. *1 Bit handling instructions: CLB, SEB *2 Read-modify-write instruction: Reads 1-byte of data from memory, modifies the data, and writes 1-byte of the data to the original memory. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 123 of 134 38D5 Group 3. Direction Registers The values of the port direction registers cannot be read. This means, it is impossible to use the LDA instruction, memory operation instruction when the T flag is “1”, addressing mode using direction register values as qualifiers, and bit test instructions such as BBC and BBS. It is also impossible to use bit operation instructions such as CLB and SEB, and read-modifywrite instructions to direction registers, including calculations such as ROR. To set the direction registers, use instructions such as LDM or STA. 4. Pull-Up Control Only for the pin set to input mode, pull-up is controlled by the PULL register and the segment output disable register. Notes on Termination of Unused Pins 1. Termination of Unused Pins Perform the following at the shortest possible distance (20 mm or less) from the MCU pins. (1) I/O ports Set the ports to input mode and connect each pin to VCC or VSS through a resistor of 1 k to 10 kΩ. An internal pull-up resistor can also be used for the port where the internal pull-up resister is selectable. To set the ports to output mode, leave open at “L” or “H” output. • When setting the ports to output mode and leave open, input mode in the initial state remains until the mode of the ports are switched to output mode by a program after a reset. This may cause the voltage level of the pins to be undefined and the power source current to increase while the ports remains in input mode. For any effects on the system, careful system evaluations should be implemented on the user side. • The direction registers may be changed due to a program runaway or noise, so reset the registers periodically by a program to increase the program reliability. 2. Termination Concerns (1) When setting I/O ports to input mode [1] Do not leave open <Reason> • The power source current may increase depending on the first-stage circuit. • The ports are more likely affected by noise when compared with the termination shown on the above “1. (1) I/O ports” [2] Do not connect to VCC or VSS directly <Reason> If the direction registers are changed to output mode due to a program runaway or noise, a short circuit may occur. [3] Do not connect multiple ports in a lump to V CC or V SS through a resistor. <Reason> If the direction registers are changed to output mode due to a program runaway or noise, a short circuit may occur between the ports. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 124 of 134 38D5 Group Notes on Interrupts 1. Changing Related Register Settings If the interrupt occurrence synchronized with the following settings is not required, take the sequence shown below. • When selecting the external interrupt active edge • When selecting the interrupt source of the interrupt vector address where two or more interrupt sources are allocated 2. Checking Interrupt Request Bit To check the interrupt request bit with the BBC or BBS instruction immediately after this bit is set to “0”, take the following sequence. <Reason> If the BBC or BBS instruction is executed immediately after the interrupt request bit is set to “0”, the bit value before being set to “0” is read. Set the corresponding interrupt enable bit to “0” (disabled). Set the interrupt request bit to “0” (no interrupt) Set the interrupt edge selection bit (active edge switch bit) or interrupt (source) selection bit. NOP (one or more instructions) Execute the BBC or BBS instruction NOP (one or more instructions) Fig. 103 Sequence for setting interrupt request bit Set the corresponding interrupt request bit to “0” (no interrupt request). Set the corresponding interrupt enable bit to “1” (enabled). Fig. 102 Sequence for setting related register <Reason> In the following cases, the interrupt request bit of the corresponding interrupt may be set to “1”. <When switching the external interrupt active edge> • INT0 interrupt edge selection bit (bit 0 of interrupt edge selection register (address 003A16)) • INT1 interrupt edge selection bit (bit 1 of interrupt edge selection register) • INT2 interrupt edge selection bit (bit 2 of interrupt edge selection register) • CNTR0 active edge switch bits (bits 6 and 7 of timer X control register 1 (address 002E16)) • CNTR1 active edge switch bit (bits 6 of timer Y mode register (address 003816)) <When switching the interrupt source of the interrupt vector address where two or more interrupt sources are allocated> • Timer Y/CNTR1 interrupt switch bit (bit 3 of interrupt edge selection register) <When switching the INT pin> • INT0 input port switch bit (bit 4 of interrupt edge selection register) • INT1 input port switch bit (bit 5 of interrupt edge select register) Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 125 of 134 3. Setting Unused Interrupts Set the interrupt enable bit of the unused interrupt to “0” (disabled). 38D5 Group Notes on Timers 8. Write Order to Timer X 1. Frequency Divider All timers shares one circuit for the frequency divider to generate the count source. Thus the frequency divider is not initialized when each individual timer is activated. When the frequency divider is selected as the count source, a one-cycle delay of the maximum count source will result between when the timer is activated and when it starts counting or outputs the waveform. The count source cannot be observed externally. (1) When timer mode, pulse output mode, event counter mode, or pulse width measurement mode is set, write to the following registers in the order below: The timer X register (extension) The timer X register (low-order) The timer X register (high-order) Writing to only one of these registers cannot be performed. When either of the above modes is set and timer X operates as a 16-bit counter, if the timer X register (extension) is never set after a reset release, setting the timer X register (extension) is not required. In that case, write the timer X register (low-order) first and the timer X register (high-order) next. However, once the timer X register (extension) is written, note that the value is retained in the reload latch. (2) Write to the timer X register by the 16-bit unit. Do not read the timer X register while write operation is performed. If the write operation is not completed, normal operation will not be performed. (3) When IGBT output mode or PWM mode is set, do not write “1” to the timer X register (extension). If “1” has been already written to the timer X register, be sure to write “0” to the register before use. Write to the following registers in the order below: The compare registers 1, 2, 3 (high- and low-order) The timer X register (extension) The timer X register (low-order) The timer X register (high-order) The compare registers (high- and low-order) can be written in either order. However, be sure to write both the compare registers 1, 2, 3 and the timer X register at the same time. 2. Division Ratio for Timer 1 to 4 The division ratio is 1/(n+1) when the value n (0 to 255) is written to the timer latch. 3. Switching Frequency and Count Source for Timer 1 to 4, X, and Y Switch the frequency division or count source* while the timer count is stopped. *This also applies when the frequency divider output is selected as the timer count source and the count source is switched in conjunction with a transition between operating modes (onchip oscillator mode, XIN mode, or low-speed mode). Be careful when changing settings in the CPU mode register. 4. Setting Timer 1 and 2 When STP Instruction Executed Before executing the STP instruction, first set the wait time at return. 5. Setting Order to Timer 1 to 4 When switching the count source of timer 1 to timer 4, a narrow pulse may be generated at the count input, which causes the timer count value to be undefined. Also, if the timers are used in cascade connection, a narrow pulse may be generated at the output when writing to the pervious timer, which causes the next timer count value to be undefined. Thus set the value from timer 1 in order after setting the count source of timer 1 to timer 4. 6. Write to Timer 2, 3, and 4 When writing to the latch only, if the write timing to the reload latch and the underflow timing are almost the same, the value is set into the timer and the timer latch at the same time. At this time, count is stopped during write operation to the reload latch. 7. Timer 3 PWM0 Mode, Timer 4 PWM1 Mode (1) When PWM output is suspended once it starts, the time to resume outputting may be delayed one section (256 × ts) of the short interval depending on the level of the output pulse at that time: Stop at “H”: No output delay Stop at “L”: Output is delayed time of 256 × ts (2) When PWM mode is used, the interrupt requests and values of timer 3 and timer 4 are updated every cycle of the long interval (4 × 256 × ts). Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 126 of 134 9. Read Order to Timer X (1) In all modes, read the following registers in the order below: The timer X register (extension) The timer X register (high-order) The timer X register (low-order) When reading the timer X register (extension) is not required, read the timer X register (high-order) first and the timer X register (low-order) next. The read order to the compare registers 1, 2, 3 is not specified. (2) Read the timer X register in 16-bit units. Do not write to it during read operation. If read operation is terminated in progress, normal operation will not be performed. 38D5 Group 10. Write to Timer X (1) Timer X can select either writing data to both the latch and the timer at the same time or writing data only by the timer X write control bit (b3) in the timer X mode register (address 002D16). When writing to the latch only, if a value is written to the timer X address, the value is set into the reload latch and the timer is updated at the next underflow. After a reset release, if a value is written to the timer X address, the value is set into the timer and the timer latch at the same time, because they are written simultaneously. When writing to the latch only, if the write timing to the high-order reload latch and the underflow timing are almost the same, the value is set into the timer and the timer latch at the same time. At this time, count is stopped during write operation to the high-order reload latch. (2) Switch the frequency division or count source* while the timer count is stopped. *This also applies when the frequency divider output is selected as the timer count source and the count source is switched in conjunction with a transition between operating modes (onchip oscillator mode, XIN mode, or low-speed mode). Be careful when changing settings in the CPU mode register. 11. Setting Timer X Mode Register When PWM mode or IGBT output mode is set, be sure to set the write control bit in the timer X mode register to “1” (writing to latch only). After writing to the timer X register (high-order), the contents of both registers are simultaneously reflected in the output waveform at the next underflow. 12. Timer X Output Control Functions To use the output control functions (INT1 and INT2 ), set the levels of INT1 and INT2 to “H” for the falling edge active or to “L” for the rising edge active before switching to IGBT output mode. 13. CNTR0 Active Edge Selection (1) Setting the CNTR0 active edge switch bits also affects the interrupt active edge at the same time. (2) When the pulse width is measured, set bit 7 of the CNTR0 active edge switch bits to “0”. 14. When Timer X Pulse Width Measurement Mode Used When timer X pulse mode measurement mode is used, enable the event counter wind control data (bit 5 of timer X mode register (address 002D16)) by setting to “0”. <Reason> If the event counter window control data (bit 5 of timer X mode r egister (address 002 D 1 6 )) is set to “1 ” (disabled) to enable/disable the CNTR0 input, the input is not accepted after the timer 1 underflow. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 127 of 134 15. CNTR1 Active Edge Selection Setting the CNTR 1 active edge switch bits also affects the interrupt active edge at the same time. However, in pulse width HL continuous HL measurement mode, the CNTR 1 interrupt request is generated at both rising and falling edges of the pin regardless of the settings of the CNTR1 active edge switch bits. 16. Read from/Write to Timer Y (1) When reading from/writing to timer Y, read from/write to both the high-order and low-order bytes of timer Y. To read the value, read the high-order bytes first and the low-order bytes next. To write the value, write the low-order bytes first and the high-order bytes next. Writing/reading should be preformed in 16-bit units. If write/read operation is changed in progress, normal operation will not be performed. (2) Timer Y can select either writing data to both the latch and the timer at the same time or writing data only by the timer Y write control bit (b0) in the timer Y control register (address 003916). When writing to the latch only, if a value is written to the timer Y address, the value is set into the reload latch and the timer is updated at the next underflow. After a reset release, if a value is written to the timer Y address, the value is set into the timer and the timer latch at the same time, because they are written simultaneously. When writing to the latch only, if the write timing to the high-order reload latch and the underflow timing are almost the same, the value is set into the timer and the timer latch at the same time. At this time, count is stopped during write operation to the high-order reload latch. (3) Switch the frequency division or count source* while the timer count is stopped. *This also applies when the frequency divider output is selected as the timer count source and the count source is switched in conjunction with a transition between operating modes (onchip oscillator mode, XIN mode, or low-speed mode). Be careful when changing settings in the CPU mode register. 38D5 Group Notes on Serial I/O1 1. Write to Baud Rate Generator Write to the baud rate generator while transmission/reception is stopped. 2. Setting Sequence When Serial I/O1 Transmit Interrupt Used To use the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt, if the interrupt occurrence synchronized with settings is not required, take the following sequence: (1) Set the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt enable bit (bit 2 of interrupt control register 2 (address 003F 16 )) to “0” (disabled). (2) Set the transmit enable bit to “1”. (3) After one or more instructions have been executed, set the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt request bit (bit 2 of interrupt request register 2 (address 003D16)) to “0” (no interrupt). (4) Set the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt enable bit to “1” (enabled). <Reason> When the transmit enable bit is set to “1”, the transmit buffer empty flag (bit 0 of serial I/O1 status register) and the transmit shift completion flag are set to “1”. This allows an interrupt request to be generated regardless of which interrupt occurrence source has been selected by the transmit interrupt source selection bit (bit 3 of serial I/O1 control register) and the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt request bit is set to “1”. 3. Data Transmission Control Using Transmit Shift Completion Flag After transmit data is written to the transmit buffer register, the transmit shift completion flag (bit 2 of serial I/O1 status register (address 001916)) changes from “1” to “0” after a delay of 0.5 to 1.5 cycles of the system clock. Thus, after transmit data is written to the transmit buffer register, note this delay when controlling data transmission by referencing the transmit shift completion flag. 4. Setting Serial I/O1 Control Register Before setting the serial I/O1 control register again, first set both the transmit enable bit and the receive enable bit to “0” and initialize the transmission and reception circuits. Set both the transmit enable bit (TE) and the receive enable bit (RE) to “0” Set bits 0 to 3, and 6 of the serial I/O1 control register. Set both the transmit enable bit (TE) and the receive enable bit (RE), or one of them to “1”. Settings can be made with the LDM instruction at the same time Fig. 104 Sequence of setting serial I/O1 control register 5. Pin Status After Transmission Completed After transmission is completed, the TxD pin retains the level when transmission is completed. When the internal clock is selected in clock synchronous serial I/O mode, the SCLK1 pin is set to “H”. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 128 of 134 6. Serial I/O1 Enable Bit during Transmit Operation During transmission, if the serial I/O1 enable bit (bit 7 of serial I/O1 control register (address 001A16 )) is set to “0”, the pin function is set to an I/O port and the internal transmit operation continues even though transmit data is not output externally. Also, if the transmit buffer register is written in this state, transmit operation starts internally. If the serial I/O1 enable bit is set to “1” at this time, transmit data is output to the TxD pin from that point. 7. Transmission Control When External Clock Selected During data transmission, if the external clock is selected as the synchronous clock, set the transmit enable bit to “1” while SCLK1 is set to “H”. Also, write to the transmit buffer register while SCLK1 is set to “H”. 8. Receive Operation in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode During reception in clock synchronous serial I/O mode, set both the transmit enable bit and the receive enable bit to “1”. Then write dummy data to the transmit buffer register. When the internal clock is selected as the synchronous clock, the synchronous clock is output at this point and receive operation starts. When the external clock is selected, reception is enabled at this point and inputting the external clock starts transmit operation. The P41/TxD pin outputs dummy data written in the transmit buffer register. 9. Transmit/Receive Operation in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode In clock synchronous serial I/O mode, set the transmit enable bit and the receive enable bit to “0” simultaneously to stop transmit/receive operations. If only one of the operations is stopped, transmission and reception cannot be synchronized, which will cause a bit error. Notes on Serial I/O2 1. Switching Synchronous Clock If the synchronous clock is switched by the serial I/O2 synchronous clock selection bit (bit 6 of serial I/O2 control register (address 001D 16 )), initialize the serial I/O2 counter (writing to serial I/O2 register (address 001F16)). 2. Notes When External Clock Selected When the external clock is selected as the synchronous clock, the SOUT2 pin retains the D7 level after transfer is completed. However, if the synchronous clock is continuously input, the serial I/O2 register continues shifting and the SOUT2 pin keeps outputting transmit data. Also, write to the serial I/O2 register while SCLK2 is set to “H”. When the internal clock is selected as the synchronous clock, the SOUT2 pin is placed in the high-impedance state after transfer is completed. 38D5 Group Notes on A/D Conversion 1. Analog Input Pin Set the signal source impedance for analog input low, or equip an analog input pin with an external capacitor of 0.01 µF to 1 µF. In addition, operations of application products should be verified thoroughly on the user side. <Reason> An analog input pin has a built-in capacitor for analog voltage comparison. Thus if a signal from the high impedance signal source is input to the analog input pin, charge and discharge noise will be generated. This may cause the A/D conversion/comparison accuracy to drop. 2. Clock Frequency during A/D Conversion The comparator input consists of a capacity coupling. If the conversion rate is too low, the A/D conversion accuracy may deteriorate due to a charge lost, so set f(XIN) 500 kHz or more for A/D conversion in XIN mode. Also, do not execute the STP or WIT instruction during A/D conversion. In low-speed mode (when on-chip oscillator is selected), as A/D conversion is performed using the internal on-chip oscillator, there is no limit on the minimum frequency for f(XIN). 3. ADKEY Function When the ADKEY enable bit is set to “1”, the analog input pin selection bits are disabled. Do not execute the A/D conversion by a program while ADKEY is enabled. Enabling ADKEY does not change bits 0 to 2 of ADCON. 4. A/D Conversion Immediately After ADKEY Function Started In the ADKEY function, A/D conversion is not performed to the analog input voltage immediately after starting the function. This causes the A/D conversion result immediately after starting the function to be undefined. If the A/D conversion result of the analog input voltage applied to the ADKEY pin is required, select the analog input pin corresponding to ADKEY before performing A/D conversion. 5. Input Voltage Applied to ADKEY Pin Set the input to the ADKEY pin into a steep falling waveform and stabilize the input voltage within eight cycles (1 µs when f(XIN) = 8 MHz) from the moment the input voltage reaches VIL or lower. The actual threshold voltage for the ADKEY pin is between VIH and VIL. To prevent unnecessary ADKEY operation due to noise or other factors, set the ADKEY pin voltage to VIH (0.9 VCC) or more while the input is waited. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 129 of 134 6. Register Operation during A/D Conversion The A/D conversion operation is not guaranteed if the following are preformed: • The CPU mode register is operated during A/D conversion operation • The AD control register is operated during A/D conversion operation • The STP or WIT instruction is executed during A/D conversion operation 7. A/D Converter Power Source Pin Connect to the A/D converter power source pin to AVSS or VSS whether the A/D conversion function is used or not. <Reason> If the AVSS pin is left open, the MCU may operate incorrectly because the pin will be affected by noise or other factors. 38D5 Group Notes on LCD Drive Control Circuit 1. Multiplier Circuit When the multiplier circuit is used, set the multiplier circuit control bit to “1” (multiplier circuit enabled) after applying a voltage from 1.3 V or more to 2.1 V or less to the VL1 pin. When the multiplier circuit is not used, set the VL3 connection bit to “1” (open) and apply an appropriate voltage to the LCD power source input pins (VL1 to VL3). When the VL3 connection bit is set open, the VL3 pin is placed in the high impedance state. When the multiplier circuit is used, set the LCDCK frequency to 100 Hz or more. The on-chip oscillator cannot be used as LCDCK. In a system where the multiplier circuit is used (a multiplier capacitor is externally connected between the C1 and C2 pins), set the multiplier circuit control bit to “1” (multiplier circuit enabled) before executing the STP or WIT instruction. 2. Setting Data to LCD Display RAM To write data to the LCD display RAM when the LCD enable bit is set to “1” and while LCD is turned on, set fixed data. Rewriting with temporary data may cause LCD to flicker. The following shows a processing example to write data to the LCD display RAM while LCD is turned on. (1) Correct processing *Content at address 0840 16: “FF16” LCD on Off LCD on or off? On LCD on or off Set LCD display RAM data LRAM0 (address 084016) ← “FF16” Set LCD display RAM data LRAM0 (address 084016) ←“0016” • Set fixed data to LCD display RAM (2) Incorrect processing LCD on *Content at address 0840 16: “FF16” Set LCD display RAM data LRAM0 (address 084016) ← “0016” LCD off • Set off data to LCD display RAM Off LCD on or off? On LCD on or off Set LCD display RAM data LRAM0 (address 084016) ← “FF16” • Set fixed data to LCD display RAM Fig. 105 Processing example when writing data to LCD display RAM While LCD Turned On Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 130 of 134 38D5 Group 3. Executing STP Instruction Executing the STP instruction sets the LCD enable bit (bit 4 of LCD mode register1 (address 001316)) to “0” and the LCD panel turns off. To turn the LCD panel on after returning from stop mode, set the LCD enable bit to “1”. 5. Using No ROM Correction Function If the ROM correction function is not used, the ROM correction vector can be used as normal RAM/ROM. When using as normal RAM/ROM, be sure to set bits 1 and 0 of the ROM correction enable register to “0” (disabled). 4. VL3 Pin To use the LCD drive control circuit while VL3 is set to the voltage equal to VCC, apply the VCC voltage to the VL3 pin and write “1” to the VL3 connection bit (bit 1 of LCD mode register 2 (address 001416)). Notes on Clock Generating Circuit 5. LCD Drive Power Supply Power supply capacitor may be insufficient with the division resistance for LCD power supply, and the characteristic of the LCD panel. In this case, there is the method of connecting the bypass capacitor about 0.1 -0.33 µ F to VL1 -VL3 pins. The example of a strengthening measure of the LCD drive power supply is shown below. VL3 VL2 • Connect by the shortest possible wiring. • Connect the bypass capacitor to the VL1 −VL3 pins as short as possible. (Referential value:0.1−0.33 µF) VL1 Fig. 106 Strengthening measure example of LCD drive power supply Notes on ROM Correction Function 1. Returning to Main Program To return to the main program from the correction program, use the JMP instruction (3-byte instruction). 2. Using ROM Correction Function If the ROM correction function is used, be sure to enable the ROM correction enable bit after setting the ROM correction register. 3. Address Do not set addresses other than the ROM area in the ROM correction address registers. Also, do not set the same address in the ROM correction address 1 register and the ROM correction address 2 register. 4. ROM Correction Process Include the ROM correction process in the program beforehand. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 131 of 134 1. Oscillation Circuit Constants The oscillation circuit constants vary depending on the resonator. Use values recommended by the oscillator manufacturer. A feed-back resistor is implemented between the XIN and XOUT pins (an external feed-back resistor may be required depending on conditions). As no feed-back resistor is implemented between XCIN and XCOUT, add a feedback resistor of about 10 MΩ. 2. Transition between Modes When the MCU transits between on-chip oscillator mode, XIN mode, or low-speed mode, both the XIN and XCIN oscillations must be stabilized. Be especially careful when turning the power on and returning from stop mode. Refer to the clock state transition diagram for a transition between each mode. Also, set the frequency in the condition that f(XIN) ≥ 3 × (XCIN). When X IN mode is not used (the X IN -X OUT oscillation or external clock input to XIN is not performed), connect XIN to VCC through a resistor. 3. Oscillation Stabilization Before executing the STP instruction, set the values * to generate the wait time required for oscillation stabilization to timer 1 latch and timer 2 latch (low-order 8 bits of timer 1 and high-order 8 bits of timer 2). *Referential values (Set values according to your oscillator and system) • OSCSEL = “L” in the flash memory and QzROM versions: ..................................................................... 000516 or more • OSCSEL = “H” in the QzROM version: .....................................................................01FF16 or more 4. Low-Speed Mode, XIN Mode To use low-speed mode or X IN mode, wait until oscillation stabilizes after enabling the X IN -X OUT and X CIN -X COUT oscillation, then switch to the mode. 38D5 Group Notes on Flash Memory Mode • CPU Rewrite Mode (1) Operating Speed During CPU rewrite mode, set the system clock φ to 4.0 MHz or less using the main clock division ratio selection bits (bits 6 and 7 of address 003B16). (2) Prohibited Instructions During CPU rewrite mode, the instructions which reference data in the flash memory cannot be used. (3) Interrupts During CPU rewrite mode, interrupts cannot be used because they reference data in the flash memory. (4) Watchdog Timer If the watchdog timer has been running already, the internal reset by underflow will not occur because the watchdog timer is continuously cleared during program or erase operation. (5) Reset Reset is always valid. If CNVSS = “H” when a reset is released, boot mode is active. The program starts from the address stored in addresses FFFC16 and FFFD16 in boot ROM area. Notes on Watchdog Timer 1. Watchdog Timer Underflow The watchdog timer does not operate in stop mode, but it continues counting during the wait time to release the stop state and in wait mode. Write to the watchdog timer control register so that the watchdog timer will not underflow during these periods. 2. Stopping On-Chip Oscillator Oscillation When the on-chip oscillator is selected by the watchdog timer count source selection bit 2, the on-chip oscillator forcibly oscillates and it cannot be stopped. Also, in this time, set the STP instruction function selection bit to “1” at this time. Select “0” (φ SOURCE) for the watchdog timer count source selection bit 2 at the system which on-chip oscillator is stopped. 3. Watchdog Timer Control Register Bits 7 to 5 can be rewritten only once after a reset. After writing, rewriting is disabled because they are locked. These bits are set to “0” after a reset. Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 132 of 134 Notes on Differences between Flash Memory Version and QzROM Version The flash memory and QzROM versions differ in their manufacturing processes, built-in ROM, memory size, and layout patterns. Because of these differences, characteristic values, operation margins, noise immunity, and noise radiation and oscillation circuit constants may vary within the specified range of electrical characteristics. When switching to the QzROM version, implement system evaluations equivalent to those performed in the flash memory version. Confirm page 11 about the differences of functions. Notes on Power Source Voltage When the power supply voltage value of the MCU is less than the value indicated in the recommended operating conditions, the MCU may not operate normally and perform unstable operation. In a system where the power source voltage drops slowly when the power source voltage drops or the power is turned off, reset the MCU when the power source voltage is less than the recommended operating conditions, and design the system so that this unstable operation does not cause errors to it. Notes on Handling Power Source Pins Before using the MCU, connect a capacitor suitable for high frequencies as a bypass capacitor between the following: The power source pin (VCC pin) and the GND pin (VSS pin) The power source pin (VCC pin) and the analog power source input pin (AVSS pin). As a bypass capacitor, a ceramic capacitor of 0.01 µF to 0.1 µF is recommended. Also, use the shortest possible wiring to connect a bypass capacitor between the power source pin and the GND pin and between the power source pin and the analog power source pin. Notes on Memory 1. RAM The RAM content is undefined at a reset. Be sure to set the initial value before use. 38D5 Group Notes on QzROM Version Wiring to OSCSEL pin (1) OSCSEL = L Connect the OSCSEL pin the shortest possible to the GND pattern which is supplied to the VSS pin of the microcomputer. In addition connecting an approximately 5 kΩ resistor in series to the GND could improve noise immunity. In this case as well as the above mention, connect the pin the shortest possible to the GND pattern which is supplied to the V S S pin of the microcomputer. (2) OSCSEL = H Connect the OSCSEL pin the shortest possible to the VCC pattern which is supplied to the V CC pin of the microcomputer. In addition connecting an approximately 5 kΩ resistor in series to the VCC could improve noise immunity. In this case as well as the above mention, connect the pin the shortest possible to the VCC pattern which is supplied to the VCC pin of the microcomputer. <Reason> The OSCSEL pin is the power source input pin for the built-in QzROM. When programming in the QzROM, the impedance of the OSCSEL pin is low to allow the electric current for writing to flow into the built-in QzROM. Because of this, noise can enter easily. If noise enters the OSCSEL pin, abnormal instruction codes or data are read from the QzROM, which may cause a program runaway. Termination of OSCSEL pin (2) OSCSEL = H (1) OSCSEL = L (1) (1) The shortest The shortest VCC OSCSEL about 5 kΩ about 5 kΩ OSCSEL VSS (1) The shortest (1) The shortest Note 1: It shows the microcomputer’s pin Fig. 107 Wiring for OSCSEL pin Overvoltage in QzROM Version Make sure that voltage exceeding the VCC pin voltage is not applied to other pins. In particular, ensure that the state indicated by bold lines in figure below does not occur for pin OSCSEL pin (VPP power source pin for QzROM) during power-on or poweroff. Otherwise the contents of QzROM could be rewritten. QzROM Version Product Shipped in Blank As for the product shipped in blank, Renesas does not perform the writing test to user ROM area after the assembly process though the QzROM writing test is performed enough before the assembly process. Therefore, a writing error of approximate 0.1% may occur. Moreover, please note the contact of cables and foreign bodies on a socket, etc. because a writing environment may cause some writing errors. Ordering QzROM Writing 1. Notes On QzROM Writing Orders When ordering the QzROM product shipped after writing, submit the mask file (extension: .msk) which is made by the mask file converter MM. • Be sure to set the ROM option data* setup when making the mask file by using the mask file converter MM.. The ROM code protect is specified according to the ROM option data* in the mask file which is submitted at ordering. Note that the mask file which has nothing at the ROM option data* or has the data other than “00 16 ”, “FE 16 ” and “FF 16 ” can not be accepted. • Set “FF16” to the ROM code protect address in ROM data regardless of the presence or absence of a protect. When data other than “FF 16” is set, we may ask that the ROM data be submitted again. * ROM option data: mask option noted in MM 2. Data Required for QzROM Ordering The following are necessary when ordering a QzROM product shipped after writing: • QzROM Writing Confirmation Form* • Mark Specification Form* • ROM data: Mask file * For the QzROM writing confirmation form and the mark specification form, refer to the “Renesas Technology Corp.” Homepage (http://www.renesas.com/homepage.jsp). Note that we cannot deal with special font marking (customer's trademark etc.) in QzROM microcomputer. 3. QzROM Product Receiving Procedure When writing to QzROM is performed by user side, the receiving inspection by the following flow is necessary. QzROM product shipped after writing QzROM product shipped in blank “protect disabled” “protect enabled to the protect area 1” Renesas (1) ∼ ∼ 1.8V (2) Renesas Programming 1.8V Shipping VCC pin voltage Verify test ∼ ∼ OSCSEL pin voltage “H” input User Shipping Receiving inspection (Blank check) User ∼ ∼ OSCSEL pin voltage “L” input (1) Input voltage to other MCU pins rises before VCC pin voltage. (2) Input voltage to other MCU pins falls after VCC pin voltage. Note: The internal circuitry is unstable when VCC is below the minimum voltage specification of 1.8 V (shaded portion), so particular care should be exercised regarding overvoltage. Fig. 108 Timing Diagram (Bold-lined periods are applicable) Receiving inspection of unprotected area (Verify test) Programming Programming to unprotected area Verify test for all area Verify test for unprotected area Fig. 109 QzROM receiving procedure Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 133 of 134 38D5 Group Notes on Flash Memory Version CPU Rewrite Mode 1. Operating Speed During CPU rewrite mode, set the system clock φ 4.0 MHz or less using the main clock division ratio selection bits (bits 6 and 7 of address 003B16). 2. Prohibited Instructions The instructions which refer to the internal data of the flash memory cannot be used during the CPU rewrite mode. 3. Interrupts The interrupts cannot be used during the CPU rewrite mode because they refer to the internal data of the flash memory. 4. Watchdog Timer In case of the watchdog timer has been running already, the internal reset generated by watchdog timer underflow does not happen, because of watchdog timer is always clearing during program or erase operation. 5. Reset Reset is always valid. In case of CNVSS = “H” when reset is released, boot mode is active. So the program starts from the address contained in address FFFC16 and FFFD16 in boot ROM area. CNVSS Pin The CNVSS pin determines the flash memory mode. Connect the CNVSS pin the shortest possible to the GND pattern which is supplied to the VSS pin of the microcomputer. In addition connecting an approximately 5 kΩ. resistor in series to the GND could improve noise immunity. In this case as well as the above mention, connect the pin the shortest possible to the GND pattern which is supplied to the V S S pin of the microcomputer. Note. When the boot mode or the standard serial I/O mode is used, a switch of the input level to the CNVSS pin is required. (1) The shortest CNVSS Approx. 5kΩ VSS (1) The shortest Note 1: Shows the microcomputer’s pin. Fig. 110 Wiring for CNVSS pin Rev.3.04 May 20, 2008 REJ03B0158-0304 Page 134 of 134 REVISION HISTORY 38D5 Group Data Sheet Rev. Date Description 1.00 Aug 12, 2005 − First edition issued 2.00 Jan 23, 2006 − Pin name revised: CNVss → OSCSEL − Frequency name revised: ROSC → OCO − Mode name revised: Middle-, High-speed mode → Frequency/2, 4, 8 mode − Bit names of some registers: 1. ROSC stop bit → On-chip oscillator stop bit 2. STP instruction disable bit → STP instruction function selection bit 3. Vector 1 enable bit (RC0) → ROM correction address 1 enable bit (RC0) 4. Vector 2 enable bit (RC1) → ROM correction address 2 enable bit (RC1) 5. Vector control bit (RC2) → ROM correction memory selection bit (RC2) 1 Description, Power source voltage and Power dissipation revised. Page Summary 6 Table 2 Pin description (1): Some description of Port P1 Function revised. 7 Table 3 Pin description (2): Description of OSCSEL added. Fig. 5 Memory expansion plan, Table 4 Support products M38D59GFFP/HP, M38D59GCFP/HP added. 13 Some description revised. Fig. 8 Structure of CPU mode register: Note on on-chip oscillator added. Fig. 9 Switch procedure of CPU mode register: Initial values of CPUM2 added and initial value of CPUM revised. 14 Fig. 10 Memory map diagram: Reserved ROM area FFD416 to FFDC16 → FFD016 to FFDC16 Note on ROM correction vector added. 15 Fig. 11 Memory map of special function register (SFR): “Reserved area” is added to address 0FFD16, and Note added. 22 Table 8 Termination of unused pins: XIN and XOUT pin termination added. 52 ROM CORRECTION FUNCTION: Description and some bit names revised and Fig. 47 Memory map of M38D58 added. 53 Initial Value of Watchdog Timer: Some description added. Standard Operation of Watchdog Timer: Some description eliminated. Bit 6 of Watchdog Timer Control Register added. Note 2 revised. Fig. 50 Structure of Watchdog timer control register: Name of bit 6 and description of its function revised. 55 Fig. 55 Reset sequence revised. 57 Fig. 56 Internal state at reset: ROM correction address 1 (low-order), ROM correction address 2 (high-order) and ROM correction address 2 (low-order) revised. 58 Oscillation Control (1) Stop Mode: Some description revised. 59 Fig. 58 Clock generating circuit block diagram: “or ROSC clock division ratio selection bit” eliminated. 60 Fig. 60 State transitions of system clock on-chip oscillator mode: f(OCO) → f(OCO)/32, Note 8 to Note 10 revised and Note 12 added. 61-65 QzROM programming mode (Overview, Pin description, Pin connection diagram, Connection example) added. 68 (6) Wiring to OSCSEL pin revised. 69 QzROM Receive Flow added. (1/7) REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 2.00 Jan 23, 2006 38D5 Group Data Sheet Description Page 2.01 2.02 Mar 24, 2006 Jul 10, 2006 Table 14 Recommended operating conditions - Vcc (Power source voltage) and Note revised. - VIH, VIL (RESET) revised. 73 Table 16 Recommended operating conditions: all revised, Power source voltage graph added. 74 Table 17 Electrical characteristics: ROSC → f(OCO) 75 Table 18 Electrical characteristics: Icc revised. Table 19 A/D converter recommended operating condition revised. 76 Table 20 A/D converter characteristics: test conditions revised. AD Power source voltage graph added. 77 Table 21 Timing requirements 1: tc(XIN), twH(XIN), twL(XIN) revised and Note added. 81 PACKAGE OUTLINE revised. 1 FEATURES: Power source voltage revised. 4 Performance overview: Oscillation frequency and Power source voltage revised. 17 Table 7 Related SFRs of port P7 revised. 52 Fig. 46: Address revised. 53 Fig. 50: Note 1 revised. 58 (1)Stop mode: Description revised. 59 Fig. 59 φSOURCE added. 60 Fig. 60 State transitions of system clock: Note 3 revised. 71 Table 14 : Vcc (Power source voltage) and Note 3 revised. 73 Table 16: Power source voltage (Main clock XIN frequency) graph added. 76 Table 20 Description of f(OCO) and Note revised. 15 Fig. 11: Register names of ROM correction addresses 1 and 2 revised. 22 Termination of unused pins 23 Table 8 • Termination 1 (recommended) : Delete (recommended). • Termination 1 to 3 of P70/C1/INT01 and P71/C2/INT11 : revised. 29 XCIN is selected as Timer 1, 2 count source : sentence is revised. 32 XCIN is selected as Timer X count source : sentence is revised. 33 Fig. 26: (TXCON1 bit 5 = “1”)→(TXCON1 bit 5 = “0”) Aug 31, 2006 I/O ports : Description added. 35 XCIN is selected as Timer Y count source : sentence is revised. 43 Fig. 38: φSOURCE clock added. 52 Fig. 47: Border line in ROM area : revised. 53 Fig. 49: On chip oscillator → On chip oscillator/4 Fig. 50: b5 and b7 revised. 58 Frequency Control : Description added. 61 Table 12: Function of VREF and AVSS revised. 64 to 67 2.03 Summary 71 Fig. 63 to Fig. 66: Revised and added. 76 Table 17: Parameter of IIH and IIC added. 4 Table 1: Main clock and Sub-clock generating circuit : “feedback resistor” eliminated. 7 Table 3: AVSS : GND → Analog power source 23 Table 8: P41/TxD : input port → output port P42/SCLK1 : output port → input port (2/7) REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 2.03 Aug 31, 2006 38D5 Group Data Sheet Description Page 2.04 Feb 02, 2007 Summary 75 Table 16: Max. of f(φ) : 2 × VCC – 4 → 4 76 Table 17: Test condition of VT+ – VT- : VCC = 2.0 V on RESET → VCC = 2.0 V to 5.5 V on RESET 13, 60 Table 24 Limits of twH (SCLK2), twL (SCLK2): tc (SCLK1)/2–80 → tc (SCLK2)/2–80 14 MEMORY ROM: Description revised. ROM Code Protect Address: Description revised and added. Fig. 10: Reserved ROM area: FFD016 → FFDB16 15 Fig.8 and Fig.60: CPUM2 (bits 2 to 7) revised. 16 • Direction Resisters: Description revised. Fig.11: ROM correction enable register → ROM correction enable register(RCR) 23 Table 8: Terminations 1 and 2 of VL3 revised. 25 • Fig.13: PULL3 (bits 4 to 7), SEG2 (bits 4 to 7) revised. 31 Fig.19: INTEDGE(bit 6), ICON2(bit 7) revised. 34 Fig.25: revised. 35 Fig. 28: Note added and revised. 36 Fig. 27: TXCON(BITS 3,4) revised. 41 Fig. 36: Note added. 43 • Fig.29: TYM(bits 2,3) revised. • [AD control Register], Fig.39: 43, 44 Fig. 38: Note added. 46 analog input selection bit → analog input pin selection bits 51 Fig. 45: 1/3 duty revised. 52 ROM CORRECTION FUNCTION: Description added. Fig. 47: FFD016 → FFDB16. 53 Fig. 49: Note added and revised. 54 Fig.40: LM2(bits 1 to 7) revised. Fig.51: CKOUT(bits 2 to 7 ) revised. 59 Fig. 59: Note 3 added and circuit expression is revised. 61 Table 12: ESDA input → ESDA input/output 64 to 66 Fig. 63 to Fig. 66: Revised. 71 Precautions Regarding Overvoltage: Description revised and Fig. 73 added. 72 Table 13 • VCC: Oscillation start voltage → When start oscillating • VI: OSCSEL added. • Vo: Conditions added. 73 Table 14 • VIL: OSCSEL added. • Note 3 revised. 75 Table 16: Note 4 revised. 78 Table 20 • TCONV Limits: (Note) → (Notes 1, 2) • Note 2 revised. 80 Note: ...set f(XIN) ≤ 500 kHz → ≥ 500 kHz Table 22 tsu (RXD-SCLK2) → tsu (SIN2-SCLK2) (3/7) REVISION HISTORY 38D5 Group Data Sheet Rev. Date Description 2.04 Feb 02, 2007 81 th (SCLK2-RXD) → th (SCLK2-SIN2) Table 23 Limits of twH (SCLK2), twL (SCLK2): tc (SCLK1)/2–30 → tc (SCLK2)/2–30 3.01 Aug 08, 2007 − 38D5 Group (Flash Memory Version For Development) Datasheet (No. REJ03B0197) is merged. 1 Flash memory version contents: added DESCRIPTION: Description added Memory size (QzROM version): 640 bytes → 1536 bytes Power dissipation (Flash memory version): revised 2 Fig. 1: Flash memory version: “M38D59FFFP” added, Notes: added 3 Fig. 2: Flash memory version: “M38D59FFHP” added, Notes: added 4 Table 1: Flash memory version contents: added and separates to Table 2 (Next page) Memory size (QzROM version); 640 bytes → 1536 bytes I/O port; 32 pins → 36 pins Page Summary 7 Table 3: I/O port P3, I/O port P4: revised 8 Table 4: OSCSEL → CNVSS/function: revised 9 Fig.4 “Memory type”: Flash memory version added 10 Memory Type: deleted Memory size (QzROM version): 640 bytes → 1536 bytes Fig. 5: Under development products → mass-produced Table 5: Flash memory version products added 11 Table 6, Notes on Differences between QzROM and Flash Memory Versions: added 12 Central Processing Unit: revised 15 Fig. 8: Flash memory version contents: added Notes: revised 16 Fig. 9: Flash memory version contents: added Low/XIN mode? → Low-speed/XIN mode? 17 Memory: Flash memory version contents: added • ROM is revised • ROM code Protect Address in QzROM version is revised Fig. 10: revised 18 Fig. 11: revised 19 Fig. 13: Do not write “1” → Not used (do not write “1”) 23 Fig. 16 (14) Port P60: Revised port Xc switch bit input to low-active 27 to 31 INTERRUPTS: revised 28 • Interrupt Source Selection: interrupt source selection register → interrupt edge selection register • External Interrupt Pin Selection: INT0, INT1 interrupt switch bit → INT0, INT1 input port switch bit 29 Fig. 19: Do not write “1” → Not used (do not write “1”) 31 <Notes>: Related registers → Related bits, and its explain is revised 34 Fig. 25: Figure title is revised P72 clock output control bit block is revised 35 • Frequency Divided For Timer: revised <Notes on Timer 1 to Timer 4>: (2)Writing to Timer 2, Timer 3, Timer 4 → (2)Write Timer 2, Timer 3, Timer4 37 Fig. 28: Figure title is revised Timer X output 1 edge switch bit → Timer X output 1 active edge switch bit (4/7) REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 3.01 Aug 08, 2007 38D5 Group Data Sheet Description Page Summary 37 Fig. 28: Timer X output 2 edge switch bit → Timer X output 2 active edge switch bit 38 • Frequency Divided For Timer: revised timer X1 output edge switch bit → timer X output 1 active edge switch bit timer X2 output edge switch bit → timer X output 2 active edge switch bit (6) Pulse Width Measurement Mode: revised 39 (1) Write Order to Timer X: description added (2) Read Order to Timer X: revised (3) Write to Timer X: revised 40 (7) When Timer X Pulse Width Measurement Mode Used: added Fig. 30: Timer X output 1 edge switch bit → Timer X output 1 active edge switch bit 41 • Timer Y: revised (5) Real Time Port Control: moved from <Notes on Timer Y> 42 • Real Time Port Control: moved to “• Timer Y” 47 • Serial I/O2: revised Fig. 39: Serial I/O counter 2 → Serial I/O2 counter Serial I/O shift register 2 → Serial I/O2 register 48 [Serial I/O2 Operation]: added Fig. 40: revised 49 [Comparator and Control Circuit]: revised 50 ADKEY function: moved from the next page. 51 Fig. 43: Added the note number to each register Do not write “1” → Not used (do not write “1”) 53 • Voltage Multiplier: revised • Bias Control and Applied Voltage to LCD Power Input Pins: evised Fig. 45: revised title is revised 56 <Notes>: added 57 Fig. 50: revised 58 • Initial Value of Watchdog Timer: revised <Notes>: revised Fig. 52: Watchdog timer selection bit 2 → Watchdog timer count source selection bit 2 Fig. 53: revised 59 Title “[RRF register] RRFR”: added 60 RESET CIRCUIT: description added Fig. 57, Fig. 58: revised 61 Fig. 59: (18) RRF register (RRFR) → (18) RRF register Notes revised 62 CLOCK GENERATING CIRCUIT, and • Frequency Control: Description added 64 • Oscillation Control: Description added 65 Fig. 63: revised 66 Table 15: Function of VCC, VSS pins: 1.8 to 5.5 → 2.7 to 5.5 69, 70 73 to 91 92 Fig. 66 and 67: revised FLASH MEMORY MODE: added NOTES ON PROGRAMMING is merged to NOTES ON USE 93 NOTES ON QzROM VERSION is separated 94 NOTES ON FLASH MEMORY VERSION and NOTES ON DEFFAERENCES BETWEEN QzROM VERSION AND FLASH MEMORY VERSION are added (5/7) REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 3.01 Aug 08, 2007 38D5 Group Data Sheet Description Page Summary 97, 108 Table 22 and 35: VI of OCESEL are added VO of COM0-COM3 are added VO of ports and SEG32-SEG35 are revised 98-106 Table 23 to 34: VSS=0V is added to test conditions 98 Table 24: VIH of RESET is revised 101 Table 27: VCC test conditions are revised 103 Table 30: At 10bitAD: 2.2V < VCC ≤ 4.0V → 2.2V ≤ VCC ≤ 4.0V 1.8V < VCC ≤ 5.5V → 2.0V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V At 8bitAD: 2.0V < VCC ≤ 2.2V → 2.0V ≤ VCC ≤ 2.2V 1.8V < VCC ≤ 5.5V → 2.0V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V 104, 115 Table 31 and 45: Each main clock input condition (VCC) are revised. 105 Table 32: 2.0V ≤ VCC ≤ 4.0V → 2.0V ≤ VCC < 4.0V VCC ≤ 2.0V → VCC < 2.0V Note 1 is added 108 Table 35: CNVSS is added Storage temperature is revised 112 Table 40: Limits value of IIL are revised 113 Table 41: All limits value are revised 113, 114 114 Table 43: 2.7V < VCC ≤ 4.0V → 2.7V ≤ VCC ≤ 4.0V 2.7V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5V and test conditions of f(OCO)/8 and f(OCO)/32 are added 115 Table 44 are added Table 45: “Main clock input “L” pulse width” is added Note 1 is revised 120-133 3.02 3.03 3.04 Sep 11, 2007 Oct 02 2007 May 20 2008 Table 41, 42, and 43: VSS=0V is added to test conditions Appendix: added 10 Table 5: Latest revised date of products list 17 Fig. 10: Brancket indicates the ROM area is modified 53 Fig. 45: VL1 external capacitor → external power supply 98 Marge the “Recommended operating conditions (1)” table and “Recommended operating conditions (2)” 109 Marge the “Recommended operating conditions (1)” table and “Recommended operating conditions (2)” 125 2nd item of “8. Write Order to Timer X” is added 126 2nd item of “10. Write to Timer X” is deleted 40 “(7) When Timer X Pulse Width Measurement Mode Used” is revised 64 Fig. 62 is revised 65 Fig. 63 is revised 76 Fig. 73 is revised Table 17 is revised 4 Table 1: LCD drive control circuit; Duty “Static” added 17 <Notes>: added 19 Fig. 11: 0FFE16, 0FFF16; “Reserved” added 20 • Direction Registers (Ports P0-P6, P72-P74) “Depending on the pin, .... may be read.” is deleted (6/7) REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 3.04 May 20 2008 38D5 Group Data Sheet Description Page Summary 21” Table 9: “P45/SIN2/(KW1)” → “P45/SOUT2/(KW1)” “P42/SCLK2/(KW2)” → “P46/SCLK2/(KW2)” “P43/SRDY2/(KW3)” → “P47/SRDY2/(KW3)” 22 Fig. 14 is revised 27 Table 10: “P20/SEG0-P27/SEG7” → “P20/SEG0/(KW4)-P27/SEG7” 68 Fig. 64: “P20/SEG0(KW4)” → “P20/SEG0/(KW4)” “P21/SEG1(KW5)” → “P21/SEG1/(KW5)” “P22/SEG2(KW6)” → “P22/SEG2/(KW6)” “P23/SEG3(KW7)” → “P23/SEG3/(KW7)” 69 Fig. 65: “P22/SEG2(KW6)” → “P22/SEG2/(KW6)” “P23/SEG3(KW7)” → “P23/SEG3/(KW7)” “P56/AN10” → “P56/AN6” 77 Fig. 73 is revised 89 Fig. 81: “P56/AN10” → “P56/AN6” 94, 133 Notes On QzROM Writing Orders is revised All trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. (7/7) Sales Strategic Planning Div. Nippon Bldg., 2-6-2, Ohte-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo 100-0004, Japan Notes: 1. This document is provided for reference purposes only so that Renesas customers may select the appropriate Renesas products for their use. Renesas neither makes warranties or representations with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the information contained in this document nor grants any license to any intellectual property rights or any other rights of Renesas or any third party with respect to the information in this document. 2. Renesas shall have no liability for damages or infringement of any intellectual property or other rights arising out of the use of any information in this document, including, but not limited to, product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, and application circuit examples. 3. You should not use the products or the technology described in this document for the purpose of military applications such as the development of weapons of mass destruction or for the purpose of any other military use. When exporting the products or technology described herein, you should follow the applicable export control laws and regulations, and procedures required by such laws and regulations. 4. All information included in this document such as product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, and application circuit examples, is current as of the date this document is issued. Such information, however, is subject to change without any prior notice. Before purchasing or using any Renesas products listed in this document, please confirm the latest product information with a Renesas sales office. Also, please pay regular and careful attention to additional and different information to be disclosed by Renesas such as that disclosed through our website. (http://www.renesas.com ) 5. Renesas has used reasonable care in compiling the information included in this document, but Renesas assumes no liability whatsoever for any damages incurred as a result of errors or omissions in the information included in this document. 6. When using or otherwise relying on the information in this document, you should evaluate the information in light of the total system before deciding about the applicability of such information to the intended application. Renesas makes no representations, warranties or guaranties regarding the suitability of its products for any particular application and specifically disclaims any liability arising out of the application and use of the information in this document or Renesas products. 7. With the exception of products specified by Renesas as suitable for automobile applications, Renesas products are not designed, manufactured or tested for applications or otherwise in systems the failure or malfunction of which may cause a direct threat to human life or create a risk of human injury or which require especially high quality and reliability such as safety systems, or equipment or systems for transportation and traffic, healthcare, combustion control, aerospace and aeronautics, nuclear power, or undersea communication transmission. If you are considering the use of our products for such purposes, please contact a Renesas sales office beforehand. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth above. 8. Notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, you should not use Renesas products for the purposes listed below: (1) artificial life support devices or systems (2) surgical implantations (3) healthcare intervention (e.g., excision, administration of medication, etc.) (4) any other purposes that pose a direct threat to human life Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth in the above and purchasers who elect to use Renesas products in any of the foregoing applications shall indemnify and hold harmless Renesas Technology Corp., its affiliated companies and their officers, directors, and employees against any and all damages arising out of such applications. 9. You should use the products described herein within the range specified by Renesas, especially with respect to the maximum rating, operating supply voltage range, movement power voltage range, heat radiation characteristics, installation and other product characteristics. Renesas shall have no liability for malfunctions or damages arising out of the use of Renesas products beyond such specified ranges. 10. Although Renesas endeavors to improve the quality and reliability of its products, IC products have specific characteristics such as the occurrence of failure at a certain rate and malfunctions under certain use conditions. Please be sure to implement safety measures to guard against the possibility of physical injury, and injury or damage caused by fire in the event of the failure of a Renesas product, such as safety design for hardware and software including but not limited to redundancy, fire control and malfunction prevention, appropriate treatment for aging degradation or any other applicable measures. Among others, since the evaluation of microcomputer software alone is very difficult, please evaluate the safety of the final products or system manufactured by you. 11. In case Renesas products listed in this document are detached from the products to which the Renesas products are attached or affixed, the risk of accident such as swallowing by infants and small children is very high. You should implement safety measures so that Renesas products may not be easily detached from your products. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of such detachment. 12. This document may not be reproduced or duplicated, in any form, in whole or in part, without prior written approval from Renesas. 13. Please contact a Renesas sales office if you have any questions regarding the information contained in this document, Renesas semiconductor products, or if you have any other inquiries. http://www.renesas.com RENESAS SALES OFFICES Refer to "http://www.renesas.com/en/network" for the latest and detailed information. Renesas Technology America, Inc. 450 Holger Way, San Jose, CA 95134-1368, U.S.A Tel: <1> (408) 382-7500, Fax: <1> (408) 382-7501 Renesas Technology Europe Limited Dukes Meadow, Millboard Road, Bourne End, Buckinghamshire, SL8 5FH, U.K. Tel: <44> (1628) 585-100, Fax: <44> (1628) 585-900 Renesas Technology (Shanghai) Co., Ltd. Unit 204, 205, AZIACenter, No.1233 Lujiazui Ring Rd, Pudong District, Shanghai, China 200120 Tel: <86> (21) 5877-1818, Fax: <86> (21) 6887-7858/7898 Renesas Technology Hong Kong Ltd. 7th Floor, North Tower, World Finance Centre, Harbour City, Canton Road, Tsimshatsui, Kowloon, Hong Kong Tel: <852> 2265-6688, Fax: <852> 2377-3473 Renesas Technology Taiwan Co., Ltd. 10th Floor, No.99, Fushing North Road, Taipei, Taiwan Tel: <886> (2) 2715-2888, Fax: <886> (2) 3518-3399 Renesas Technology Singapore Pte. Ltd. 1 Harbour Front Avenue, #06-10, Keppel Bay Tower, Singapore 098632 Tel: <65> 6213-0200, Fax: <65> 6278-8001 Renesas Technology Korea Co., Ltd. Kukje Center Bldg. 18th Fl., 191, 2-ka, Hangang-ro, Yongsan-ku, Seoul 140-702, Korea Tel: <82> (2) 796-3115, Fax: <82> (2) 796-2145 Renesas Technology Malaysia Sdn. Bhd Unit 906, Block B, Menara Amcorp, Amcorp Trade Centre, No.18, Jln Persiaran Barat, 46050 Petaling Jaya, Selangor Darul Ehsan, Malaysia Tel: <603> 7955-9390, Fax: <603> 7955-9510 © 2008. Renesas Technology Corp., All rights reserved. Printed in Japan. Colophon .7.2